blob: a1f58fb05dc252dd94c14dbe0315670fc6062d2f [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02007 2014/04/23
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
451 - gid
452 - group
453 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100454 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - nbproc
456 - pidfile
457 - uid
458 - ulimit-n
459 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200460 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100461 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200462 - node
463 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100464 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200467 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200469 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100470 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100471 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200473 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200474 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200475 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476 - noepoll
477 - nokqueue
478 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100479 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300480 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200481 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200482 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200483 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100484 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100485 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200486 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100487 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100488 - tune.maxaccept
489 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200490 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200491 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100492 - tune.rcvbuf.client
493 - tune.rcvbuf.server
494 - tune.sndbuf.client
495 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100496 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100497 - tune.ssl.lifetime
498 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100499 - tune.zlib.memlevel
500 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100501
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200502 * Debugging
503 - debug
504 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200505
506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005073.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200508------------------------------------
509
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200510ca-base <dir>
511 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200512 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
513 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200514
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200515chroot <jail dir>
516 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
517 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
518 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
519 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
520 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
521 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100522
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100523cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
524 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
525 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
526 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
527 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
528 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
529 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
530 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
531 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
532 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
533 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
534 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
535 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
536 they overlap.
537
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200538crt-base <dir>
539 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
540 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
541 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
542
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200543daemon
544 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
545 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
546 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
547
548gid <number>
549 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
550 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
551 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100552 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
553 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200554 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100555
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556group <group name>
557 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
558 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100559
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200560log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200561 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
562 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100563 configured with "log global".
564
565 <address> can be one of:
566
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100567 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100568 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
569 port).
570
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100571 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
572 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
573 port).
574
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100575 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
576 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
577 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
578 writeable).
579
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100580 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
581 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
582 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
583 in Bourne shell.
584
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100585 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200586
587 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
588 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
589 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
590
591 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200592 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
593 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
594 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
595 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
596 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
597 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200599 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200600
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100601log-send-hostname [<string>]
602 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
603 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
604 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
605 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
606 the logs.
607
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000608log-tag <string>
609 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
610 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
611 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
612 running on the same host.
613
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614nbproc <number>
615 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
616 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
617 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
618 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
619 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
620
621pidfile <pidfile>
622 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
623 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
624 starting the process. See also "daemon".
625
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100626stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200627 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
628 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
629 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
630 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
631 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
632 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
633 the number of processes used.
634
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100635ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
636 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
637 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300638 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100639 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
640 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
641 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
642 "bind" keyword for more information.
643
644ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
645 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
646 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300647 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100648 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
649 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
650 information.
651
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100652ssl-server-verify [none|required]
653 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
654 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
655 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
656
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200657stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
658 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
659 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
660 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
661 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200662
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200663 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
664 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
665 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200666
667stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
668 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
669 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100670 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200671
672stats maxconn <connections>
673 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
674 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
675
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200676uid <number>
677 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
678 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
679 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
680 one. See also "gid" and "user".
681
682ulimit-n <number>
683 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
684 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
685 option.
686
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100687unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
688 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
689
690 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
691 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
692 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
693 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
694 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
695 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
696 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
697 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
698 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
699 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
700
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200701user <user name>
702 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
703 See also "uid" and "group".
704
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200705node <name>
706 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
707
708 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
709 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
710 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
711 traffic.
712
713description <text>
714 Add a text that describes the instance.
715
716 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
717 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
718 "<" and ">" characters.
719
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007213.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200722-----------------------
723
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200724max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
725 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
726 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
727 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
728 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
729 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
730 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
731 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
732 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
733
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200734maxconn <number>
735 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
736 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
737 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
738 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
739
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200740maxconnrate <number>
741 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
742 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
743 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
744 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
745 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
746 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
747 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
748 fairness.
749
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100750maxcomprate <number>
751 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300752 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100753 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
754 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
755 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
756 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
757 default value.
758
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100759maxcompcpuusage <number>
760 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
761 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
762 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
763 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
764 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
765 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
766 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
767 process down and from introducing high latencies.
768
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100769maxpipes <number>
770 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
771 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
772 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
773 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
774 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
775 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
776
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200777maxsessrate <number>
778 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
779 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
780 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
781 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
782 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
783 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
784 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
785 fairness.
786
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200787maxsslconn <number>
788 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
789 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
790 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
791 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
792 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
793 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
794 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
795
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200796maxsslrate <number>
797 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
798 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
799 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
800 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
801 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
802 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
803 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
804 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
805 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
806 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
807
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100808maxzlibmem <number>
809 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
810 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
811 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100812 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
813 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
814 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
815
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200816noepoll
817 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
818 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100819 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820
821nokqueue
822 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
823 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
824 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
825
826nopoll
827 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
828 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100829 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100830 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200831
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100832nosplice
833 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
834 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
835 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100836 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100837 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
838 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
839 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
840 "option splice-response".
841
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300842nogetaddrinfo
843 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
844 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
845
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200846spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900847 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
848 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
849 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
850 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
851 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
852 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200853
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200854tune.bufsize <number>
855 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
856 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
857 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
858 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
859 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
860 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
861 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
862 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400863 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
864 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
865 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200866
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200867tune.chksize <number>
868 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
869 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
870 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
871 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
872 checks whenever possible.
873
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100874tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
875 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
876 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
877 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
878 this value. The default value is 1.
879
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100880tune.http.cookielen <number>
881 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
882 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
883 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
884 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
885 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
886 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
887 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
888 to change this value.
889
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200890tune.http.maxhdr <number>
891 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
892 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
893 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
894 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
895 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
896 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
897 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
898 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
899 limit too high.
900
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100901tune.idletimer <timeout>
902 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
903 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
904 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
905 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
906 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
907 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
908 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
909 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
910 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
911
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100912tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100913 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
914 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
915 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
916 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
917 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
918 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
919 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
920 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
921 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
922 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100923
924tune.maxpollevents <number>
925 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
926 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
927 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
928 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
929 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
930
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200931tune.maxrewrite <number>
932 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
933 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
934 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
935 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
936 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
937 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
938 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
939 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
940 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
941 bufsize.
942
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200943tune.pipesize <number>
944 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
945 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
946 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
947 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
948 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
949 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
950
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100951tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
952tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
953 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
954 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
955 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
956 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
957 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
958 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
959 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
960
961tune.sndbuf.client <number>
962tune.sndbuf.server <number>
963 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
964 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
965 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
966 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
967 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
968 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
969 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
970 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
971 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
972 notifying haproxy again.
973
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100974tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100975 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
976 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
977 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300978 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100979 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
980 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
981 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
982 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
983 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100984 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
985 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100986
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100987tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
988 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300989 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100990 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
991 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
992 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
993 being used for too long.
994
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100995tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
996 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
997 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
998 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
999 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1000 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1001 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1002 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1003 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1004 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1005 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001006 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1007 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001008
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001009tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1010 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001011 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001012 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1013 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1014 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1015
1016tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1017 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1018 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1019 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1020 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001021
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010223.3. Debugging
1023--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001024
1025debug
1026 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1027 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1028 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1029 system startup.
1030
1031quiet
1032 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1033 line argument "-q".
1034
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001035
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010363.4. Userlists
1037--------------
1038It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1039http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1040it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1041
1042userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001043 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001044 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1045
1046group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001047 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001048 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1049 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1050
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001051user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1052 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001053 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1054 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001055 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1056 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001057 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001058 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001059
1060
1061 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001062 userlist L1
1063 group G1 users tiger,scott
1064 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001065
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001066 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1067 user scott insecure-password elgato
1068 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001069
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001070 userlist L2
1071 group G1
1072 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001073
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001074 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1075 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1076 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001077
1078 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001079
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001080
10813.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001082----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001083It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1084haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1085pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1086identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1087or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1088Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1089known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1090the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1091process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1092during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1093tables.
1094
1095peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001096 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001097 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1098
1099peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1100 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1101 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1102 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1103 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1104 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1105 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1106
1107 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1108 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1109
1110 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1111 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1112 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1113 across all peers.
1114
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001115 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1116 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1117 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1118
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001119 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001120 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001121 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1122 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1123 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001124
1125 backend mybackend
1126 mode tcp
1127 balance roundrobin
1128 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1129 stick on src
1130
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001131 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1132 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001133
1134
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011354. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001136----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001137
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001138Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1139 - defaults <name>
1140 - frontend <name>
1141 - backend <name>
1142 - listen <name>
1143
1144A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1145its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1146section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001147section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001148
1149A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1150connections.
1151
1152A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1153to forward incoming connections.
1154
1155A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1156parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1157
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001158All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1159'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1160case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1161
1162Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1163logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1164proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1165However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1166name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1167
1168Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1169and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001170bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001171protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1172modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1173arbitrary criteria.
1174
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001175In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1176a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1177the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1178
1179 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1180 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1181 between responses and new requests.
1182
1183 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1184 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1185 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1186 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1187
1188 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1189 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1190 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1191
1192 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1193 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1194 client-facing connection remains open.
1195
1196 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1197 after the end of the response.
1198
1199The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1200frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1201following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1202weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1203
1204 Backend mode
1205
1206 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1207 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1208 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1209 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1210 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1211 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1212 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1213 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1214 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1215 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1216 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1217
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001218
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001219
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012204.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1221--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001223The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1224limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1225they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1226limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001227marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001228option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001229and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1230with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1231specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001232
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001233
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001234 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1235------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1236acl - X X X
1237appsession - - X X
1238backlog X X X -
1239balance X - X X
1240bind - X X -
1241bind-process X X X X
1242block - X X X
1243capture cookie - X X -
1244capture request header - X X -
1245capture response header - X X -
1246clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001247compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001248contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1249cookie X - X X
1250default-server X - X X
1251default_backend X X X -
1252description - X X X
1253disabled X X X X
1254dispatch - - X X
1255enabled X X X X
1256errorfile X X X X
1257errorloc X X X X
1258errorloc302 X X X X
1259-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1260errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001261force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001262fullconn X - X X
1263grace X X X X
1264hash-type X - X X
1265http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001266http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001267http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001268http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001269http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01001270tcp-check connect - - X X
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02001271tcp-check expect - - X X
1272tcp-check send - - X X
1273tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001274http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001275id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001276ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001277log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001278maxconn X X X -
1279mode X X X X
1280monitor fail - X X -
1281monitor-net X X X -
1282monitor-uri X X X -
1283option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1284option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1285option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1286option allbackups (*) X - X X
1287option checkcache (*) X - X X
1288option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1289option contstats (*) X X X -
1290option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1291option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1292option forceclose (*) X X X X
1293-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1294option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001295option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001296option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001297option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001298option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001299option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001300option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1301option httpchk X - X X
1302option httpclose (*) X X X X
1303option httplog X X X X
1304option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001305option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001306option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001307option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1308option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1309option logasap (*) X X X -
1310option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001311option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001312option nolinger (*) X X X X
1313option originalto X X X X
1314option persist (*) X - X X
1315option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001316option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001317option smtpchk X - X X
1318option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1319option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1320option splice-request (*) X X X X
1321option splice-response (*) X X X X
1322option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1323option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1324-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001325option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001326option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1327option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1328option tcpka X X X X
1329option tcplog X X X X
1330option transparent (*) X - X X
1331persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1332rate-limit sessions X X X -
1333redirect - X X X
1334redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1335redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1336reqadd - X X X
1337reqallow - X X X
1338reqdel - X X X
1339reqdeny - X X X
1340reqiallow - X X X
1341reqidel - X X X
1342reqideny - X X X
1343reqipass - X X X
1344reqirep - X X X
1345reqisetbe - X X X
1346reqitarpit - X X X
1347reqpass - X X X
1348reqrep - X X X
1349-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1350reqsetbe - X X X
1351reqtarpit - X X X
1352retries X - X X
1353rspadd - X X X
1354rspdel - X X X
1355rspdeny - X X X
1356rspidel - X X X
1357rspideny - X X X
1358rspirep - X X X
1359rsprep - X X X
1360server - - X X
1361source X - X X
1362srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001363stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001364stats auth X - X X
1365stats enable X - X X
1366stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001367stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001368stats realm X - X X
1369stats refresh X - X X
1370stats scope X - X X
1371stats show-desc X - X X
1372stats show-legends X - X X
1373stats show-node X - X X
1374stats uri X - X X
1375-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1376stick match - - X X
1377stick on - - X X
1378stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001379stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001380stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001381tcp-request connection - X X -
1382tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001383tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001384tcp-response content - - X X
1385tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001386timeout check X - X X
1387timeout client X X X -
1388timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1389timeout connect X - X X
1390timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1391timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1392timeout http-request X X X X
1393timeout queue X - X X
1394timeout server X - X X
1395timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1396timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001397timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001398transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001399unique-id-format X X X -
1400unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001401use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001402use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001403------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1404 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001405
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001406
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014074.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1408---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001409
1410This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1411
1412
1413acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1414 Declare or complete an access list.
1415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1416 no | yes | yes | yes
1417 Example:
1418 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1419 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1420 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1421
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001422 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001423
1424
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001425appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1426 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001427 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1429 no | no | yes | yes
1430 Arguments :
1431 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1432 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1433
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001434 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001435 checked in each cookie value.
1436
1437 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1438 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1439 milliseconds.
1440
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001441 request-learn
1442 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1443 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1444 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1445 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1446 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1447 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1448
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001449 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1450 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1451 data following this prefix.
1452
1453 Example :
1454 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1455
1456 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1457 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1458
1459 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1460 2 modes are currently supported :
1461 - path-parameters :
1462 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1463 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1464 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1465 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1466 - query-string :
1467 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1468 query string.
1469
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001470 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1471 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1472 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1473 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001474 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1475 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1476 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001477 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1478 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1479
1480 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1481
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001482 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1483 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1484 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1485
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001486 Example :
1487 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1488
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001489 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1490 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001491
1492
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001493backlog <conns>
1494 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1496 yes | yes | yes | no
1497 Arguments :
1498 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1499 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001500 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001501
1502 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1503 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1504 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1505 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1506 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1507 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1508 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1509 backlog parameter.
1510
1511 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1512 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1513 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1514
1515 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1516
1517
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001518balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001519balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001520 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1522 yes | no | yes | yes
1523 Arguments :
1524 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1525 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1526 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1527 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1528
1529 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1530 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1531 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1532 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001533 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001534 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001535 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1536 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1537 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1538 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1539 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1540 it, so that you don't worry.
1541
1542 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1543 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1544 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1545 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1546 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1547 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1548 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1549 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001550
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001551 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1552 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1553 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1554 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1555 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1556 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1557 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1558 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1559
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001560 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001561 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001562 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1563 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001564 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001565 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1566 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1567 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1568 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1569 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001570 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1571 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1572 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1573 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1574 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1575 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001576
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001577 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1578 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1579 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1580 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1581 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1582 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1583 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1584 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001585 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001586 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001587 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1588 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1589 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001590
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001591 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1592 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1593 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1594 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1595 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1596 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1597 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1598 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1599 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1600 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1601 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1602 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001603
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001604 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001605 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1606 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1607 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1608 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1609 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1610 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1611 URIs start with a leading "/".
1612
1613 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1614 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1615 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1616 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1617
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001618 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001619 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1620
1621 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001622 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1623 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001624 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1625 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1626 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1627 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001628 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001629 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1630 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001631
1632 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1633 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1634 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1635 server will receive the request.
1636
1637 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1638 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1639 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1640 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1641 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001642 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1643 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1644 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001645
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001646 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1647 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1648 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1649 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1650 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001651
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001652 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001653 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1654 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1655 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1656
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001657 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1658 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1659 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1660
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001661 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001662 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001663 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1664 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1665 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1666 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1667 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1668 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001669 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001670 used instead.
1671
1672 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1673 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1674 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1675 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1676
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001677 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1678 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1679 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1680
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001681 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001682
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001683 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001684 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1685 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001686
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001687 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1688 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1689 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001690
1691 Examples :
1692 balance roundrobin
1693 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001694 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001695 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1696 balance hdr(host)
1697 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001698
1699 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1700 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1701
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001702 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001703 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1704 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1705 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1706 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1707
1708 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1709 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1710 defaults to 16 kB.
1711
1712 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1713 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1714
1715 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1716 Round Robin.
1717
1718 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1719 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1720 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1721 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1722
1723 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1724
1725 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001726 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001727 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1728 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1729 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001730
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001731 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1732 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001733
1734
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001735bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1736bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001737 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1739 no | yes | yes | no
1740 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001741 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1742 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1743 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1744 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001745 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001746 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1747 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1748 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1749 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1750 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1751 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1752 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001753 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1754 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1755 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001756 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1757 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1758 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1759 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001760
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001761 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1762 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001763 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1764 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1765 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001766 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1767 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1768 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1769 the range.
1770
1771 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1772 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1773 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1774 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1775 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1776 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1777 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001778 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001779 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001780
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001781 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1782 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1783 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1784 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1785 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1786 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1787 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1788 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1789
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001790 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1791 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1792 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1793 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001794
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001795 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1796 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1797 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1798 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1799 in a frontend.
1800
1801 Example :
1802 listen http_proxy
1803 bind :80,:443
1804 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001805 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001806
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001807 listen http_https_proxy
1808 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001809 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001810
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001811 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1812 bind ipv6@:80
1813 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1814 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1815
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001816 listen external_bind_app1
1817 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1818
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001819 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001820 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001821
1822
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001823bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001824 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1826 yes | yes | yes | yes
1827 Arguments :
1828 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1829 may be used to override a default value.
1830
1831 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1832 option may be combined with other numbers.
1833
1834 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1835 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1836 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1837 missing from all processes.
1838
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001839 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1840 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1841 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1842 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1843 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001844
1845 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1846 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1847 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1848 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1849 and 'even' instances.
1850
1851 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1852 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1853 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1854 32.
1855
1856 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1857 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1858
1859 Example :
1860 listen app_ip1
1861 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001862 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001863
1864 listen app_ip2
1865 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001866 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001867
1868 listen management
1869 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001870 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001871
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001872 listen management
1873 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1874 bind-process 1-4
1875
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001876 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1877
1878
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001879block { if | unless } <condition>
1880 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1882 no | yes | yes | yes
1883
1884 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1885 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001886 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001887 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001888 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1889 "block" statements per instance.
1890
1891 Example:
1892 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1893 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1894 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1895 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1896
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001897 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001898
1899
1900capture cookie <name> len <length>
1901 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1903 no | yes | yes | no
1904 Arguments :
1905 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1906 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1907 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1908 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1909 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1910
1911 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1912 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1913 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1914 right if it exceeds <length>.
1915
1916 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1917 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1918 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1919 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1920
1921 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1922 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1923 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1924
1925 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1926 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1927 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001928 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1929 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1930 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001931
1932 Example:
1933 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1934
1935 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001936 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001937
1938
1939capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001940 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1942 no | yes | yes | no
1943 Arguments :
1944 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001945 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001946 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1947 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1948 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1949
1950 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1951 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1952 it exceeds <length>.
1953
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001954 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001955 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1956 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001957 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1958 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1959 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1960 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001961 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001962 environments to find where the request came from.
1963
1964 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1965 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1966 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1967 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001968
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001969 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1970 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1971 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1972 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1973 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001974
1975 Example:
1976 capture request header Host len 15
1977 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1978 capture request header Referrer len 15
1979
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001980 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001981 about logging.
1982
1983
1984capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001985 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1987 no | yes | yes | no
1988 Arguments :
1989 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001990 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001991 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1992 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1993 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1994
1995 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1996 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1997 it exceeds <length>.
1998
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001999 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002000 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2001 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2002 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002003 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2004 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2005 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2006 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002007
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002008 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2009 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2010 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2011 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2012 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002013
2014 Example:
2015 capture response header Content-length len 9
2016 capture response header Location len 15
2017
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002018 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002019 about logging.
2020
2021
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002022clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002023 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2025 yes | yes | yes | no
2026 Arguments :
2027 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2028 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2029 as explained at the top of this document.
2030
2031 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2032 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2033 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2034 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2035 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2036 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2037 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2038 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002039 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002040 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2041 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2042
2043 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2044 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2045 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2046 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2047 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2048 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2049
2050 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2051 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2052
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002053 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2054 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002055
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002056compression algo <algorithm> ...
2057compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002058compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002059 Enable HTTP compression.
2060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2061 yes | yes | yes | yes
2062 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002063 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2064 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2065 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2066
2067 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002068 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002069 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2070 data.
2071
2072 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2073 support for zlib was built in.
2074
2075 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2076 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2077 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2078 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2079 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2080 in.
2081
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002082 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002083 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002084 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2085 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2086 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2087 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2088 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002089
2090 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2091 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2092 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2093 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2094 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002095 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2096 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2097 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2098 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2099 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
2100 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002101
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002102 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002103 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2104 "Accept-Encoding" header
2105 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002106 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002107 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2108 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002109 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2110 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2111 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2112 "multipart"
2113 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2114 header
2115 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2116 and later
2117 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2118 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002119
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002120 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2121 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002122
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002123 Examples :
2124 compression algo gzip
2125 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002126
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002127contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002128 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2130 yes | no | yes | yes
2131 Arguments :
2132 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2133 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2134 as explained at the top of this document.
2135
2136 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002137 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002138 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002139 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2140 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2141 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2142 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2143
2144 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2145 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2146 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2147 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2148 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2149 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2150
2151 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2152 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2153 instead.
2154
2155 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2156 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2157
2158
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002159cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002160 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2161 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002162 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2164 yes | no | yes | yes
2165 Arguments :
2166 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2167 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2168 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2169 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2170 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2171 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2172 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2173 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2174 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2175
2176 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2177 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2178 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2179 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2180 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2181 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2182 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2183 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2184 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2185 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2186 "insert" and "prefix".
2187
2188 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002189 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002190
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002191 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002192 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2193 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2194 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2195 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2196 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2197 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2198 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2199 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2200 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2201 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002202
2203 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2204 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2205 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2206 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2207 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2208 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2209 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2210 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2211 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2212 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002213 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2214 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2215 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002216
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002217 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2218 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2219 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002220 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2221 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2222 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2223 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002224 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2225 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2226 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002227
2228 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2229 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2230 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2231 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2232 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2233 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2234 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2235 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2236 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2237
2238 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2239 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2240 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2241 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2242 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2243 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2244 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2245 persistence cookie in the cache.
2246 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2247
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002248 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2249 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2250 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2251 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2252 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2253 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2254 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2255 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2256 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2257 they logout.
2258
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002259 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2260 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2261 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2262 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2263
2264 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2265 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2266 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2267 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2268 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2269 this attribute.
2270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002271 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002272 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002273 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2274 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2275 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2276 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2277 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2278 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002279
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002280 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2281 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2282 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2283 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2284 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2285 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2286 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2287 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2288 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2289 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2290 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2291 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2292 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2293 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2294 the site.
2295
2296 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2297 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2298 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2299 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2300 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2301 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2302 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2303 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2304 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2305 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2306 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2307 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2308 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2309 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2310 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2311 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2312
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002313 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2314 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2315 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2316 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002317
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002318 Examples :
2319 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2320 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2321 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002322 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002323
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002324 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002325 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002326
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002327
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002328default-server [param*]
2329 Change default options for a server in a backend
2330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2331 yes | no | yes | yes
2332 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002333 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2334 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2335 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2336 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002337
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002338 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002339 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2340
2341 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002342
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002343
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002344default_backend <backend>
2345 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2347 yes | yes | yes | no
2348 Arguments :
2349 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2350
2351 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2352 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2353 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2354 will catch all undetermined requests.
2355
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002356 Example :
2357
2358 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2359 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2360 default_backend dynamic
2361
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002362 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2363
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002364
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002365description <string>
2366 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2368 no | yes | yes | yes
2369 Arguments : string
2370
2371 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2372 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2373 it describes.
2374 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2375
2376
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002377disabled
2378 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2380 yes | yes | yes | yes
2381 Arguments : none
2382
2383 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2384 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2385 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2386 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2387 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2388 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2389 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2390
2391 See also : "enabled"
2392
2393
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002394dispatch <address>:<port>
2395 Set a default server address
2396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2397 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002398 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002399
2400 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2401 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2402 during start-up.
2403
2404 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2405 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2406 possible with normal servers.
2407
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002408 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002409 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2410 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2411 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2412 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2413
2414 See also : "server"
2415
2416
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002417enabled
2418 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2420 yes | yes | yes | yes
2421 Arguments : none
2422
2423 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2424 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2425
2426 See also : "disabled"
2427
2428
2429errorfile <code> <file>
2430 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2432 yes | yes | yes | yes
2433 Arguments :
2434 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002435 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002436
2437 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002438 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002439 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002440 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2441 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002442
2443 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2444 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2445 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2446
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002447 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2448
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002449 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2450 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2451 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2452 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2453
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002454 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2455 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2456 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2457 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2458 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2459 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2460
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002461 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2462 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2463 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002464 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002465 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2466
2467 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2468
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002469 Example :
2470 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2471 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2472 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2473
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002474
2475errorloc <code> <url>
2476errorloc302 <code> <url>
2477 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2479 yes | yes | yes | yes
2480 Arguments :
2481 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002482 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002483
2484 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2485 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2486 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2487 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2488 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2489
2490 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2491 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2492 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2493
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002494 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2495
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002496 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2497 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2498 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2499 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2500 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2501 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2502 request.
2503
2504 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2505
2506
2507errorloc303 <code> <url>
2508 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2510 yes | yes | yes | yes
2511 Arguments :
2512 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2513 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2514
2515 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2516 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2517 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2518 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2519 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2520
2521 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2522 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2523 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2524
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002525 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2526
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002527 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2528 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2529 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2530 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002531 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002532
2533 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2534
2535
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002536force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2537 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2538 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2539 no | yes | yes | yes
2540
2541 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2542 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2543 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2544 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2545 marked down for maintenance operations.
2546
2547 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2548 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2549 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2550 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2551 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2552 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2553 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2554 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2555 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2556
2557 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2558 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2559 is used.
2560
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002561 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002562 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002563
2564
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002565fullconn <conns>
2566 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2568 yes | no | yes | yes
2569 Arguments :
2570 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2571 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2572
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002573 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002574 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002575 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002576 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2577 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2578 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2579 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2580 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002581 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002582
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002583 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2584 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002585 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2586 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2587 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002588
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002589 Example :
2590 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2591 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2592 # connections.
2593 backend dynamic
2594 fullconn 10000
2595 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2596 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2597
2598 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2599
2600
2601grace <time>
2602 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002604 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002605 Arguments :
2606 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2607 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2608 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2609
2610 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2611 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002612 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002613 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2614
2615 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2616 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2617 simplify it.
2618
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002619
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002620hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002621 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2623 yes | no | yes | yes
2624 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002625 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2626 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002627
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002628 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2629 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2630 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2631 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2632 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2633 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2634 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2635 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2636 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2637 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002638
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002639 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2640 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2641 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2642 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2643 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2644 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2645 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2646 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2647 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2648 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2649 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2650 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2651 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002652 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2653 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002654
2655 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2656
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002657 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002658 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2659 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2660 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002661 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2662 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2663 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002664
2665 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2666 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002667 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2668 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2669 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2670 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2671
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002672 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2673 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2674 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2675 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2676 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2677 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2678 parameter.
2679
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002680 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2681
2682 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2683 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2684 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2685 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2686 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2687 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2688 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2689 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2690 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2691 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2692 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2693 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002694
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002695 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2696 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2697 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002698
2699 See also : "balance", "server"
2700
2701
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002702http-check disable-on-404
2703 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002705 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002706 Arguments : none
2707
2708 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2709 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2710 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2711 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2712 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2713 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2714 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2715 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002716 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2717 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2718 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2719
2720 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2721
2722
2723http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002724 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002726 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002727 Arguments :
2728 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2729 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002730 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002731 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2732 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2733 details on the supported keywords.
2734
2735 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2736 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2737 with the usual backslash ('\').
2738
2739 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2740 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2741 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2742 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2743 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2744
2745 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002746 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002747 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2748 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2749 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2750
2751 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002752 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002753 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2754 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2755 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2756 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2757
2758 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002759 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002760 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2761 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2762 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2763 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2764 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2765 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2766 trace).
2767
2768 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002769 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002770 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2771 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2772 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2773 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2774 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2775 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2776
2777 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2778 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2779 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2780 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2781 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2782 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2783 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2784 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2785
2786 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2787 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2788
2789 Examples :
2790 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002791 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002792
2793 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002794 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002795
2796 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002797 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002798
2799 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002800 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002801
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002802 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002803
2804
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002805http-check send-state
2806 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2808 yes | no | yes | yes
2809 Arguments : none
2810
2811 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2812 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2813 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2814 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2815 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2816
2817 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2818 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2819 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2820 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2821 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2822 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2823 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2824 checked in multiple backends.
2825
2826 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2827 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2828
2829 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2830 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2831 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2832 one fails.
2833
2834 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2835 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2836 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2837
2838 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2839 server's queue.
2840
2841 Example of a header received by the application server :
2842 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2843 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2844
2845 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2846
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002847http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002848 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002849 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
2850 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002851 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002852 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2853
2854 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2855 no | yes | yes | yes
2856
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002857 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2858 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2859 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2860 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2861 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002862
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002863 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2864 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2865 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2866
2867 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2868 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2869 are evaluated.
2870
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002871 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2872 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2873 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2874 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2875 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2876 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2877 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2878 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2879 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002880 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002881 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2882
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002883 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2884 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2885 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2886 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2887 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2888
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002889 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2890 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2891 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002892 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2893 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002894
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002895 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2896 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2897 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2898 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2899 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2900 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2901 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2902 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2903
2904 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2905 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2906 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2907 external users.
2908
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002909 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2910 <name>.
2911
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002912 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2913 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2914 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2915 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2916 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2917 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2918 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2919 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2920
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002921 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2922 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2923 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2924 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2925 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2926 another equipment.
2927
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002928 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2929 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2930 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2931 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2932 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2933 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2934 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2935 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2936
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002937 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2938 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2939 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2940 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2941 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2942 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2943 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2944 admin privileges.
2945
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002946 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2947
2948 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2949 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2950 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2951 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002952
2953 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002954 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2955 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2956 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002957
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002958 http-request allow if nagios
2959 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2960 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2961 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002962
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002963 Example:
2964 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002965 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002966
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002967 Example:
2968 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2969 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2970 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2971 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2972 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2973 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2974 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2975 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2976 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2977
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002978 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2979 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002980
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002981http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002982 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
2983 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02002984 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002985 Access control for Layer 7 responses
2986
2987 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2988 no | yes | yes | yes
2989
2990 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2991 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2992 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2993 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2994 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
2995 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
2996
2997 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2998 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
2999 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3000 current section.
3001
3002 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3003 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3004 rules are evaluated.
3005
3006 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3007 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3008 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3009 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3010 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3011 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3012 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3013
3014 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3015 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3016 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3017 external users.
3018
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003019 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3020 <name>.
3021
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003022 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3023 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3024 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3025 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3026 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3027 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3028 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3029 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3030
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003031 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3032 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3033 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3034 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3035 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3036 another equipment.
3037
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003038 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3039 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3040 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3041 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3042 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3043 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3044 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3045 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3046
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003047 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3048 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3049 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3050 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3051 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3052 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3053 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3054 admin privileges.
3055
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003056 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3057
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003058 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003059 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3060 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3061 rules.
3062
3063 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3064 ACL usage.
3065
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003066
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01003067tcp-check connect [params*]
3068 Opens a new connection
3069 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3070 no | no | yes | yes
3071
3072 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
3073 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
3074 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
3075
3076 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
3077 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
3078 of the sequence.
3079
3080 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
3081 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
3082 do.
3083
3084 Parameters :
3085 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
3086 use the TCP connection.
3087
3088 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
3089 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
3090 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
3091
3092 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
3093
3094 ssl opens a ciphered connection
3095
3096 Examples:
3097 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
3098 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
3099 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
3100 option tcp-check
3101 tcp-check connect
3102 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
3103 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
3104 tcp-check send \r\n
3105 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
3106 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
3107 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
3108 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
3109 tcp-check send \r\n
3110 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
3111 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
3112
3113 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
3114 option tcp-check
3115 tcp-check connect port 110
3116 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
3117 tcp-check connect port 143
3118 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
3119 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
3120
3121 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
3122
3123
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003124tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
3125 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
3126 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3127 no | no | yes | yes
3128
3129 Arguments :
3130 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3131 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
3132 binary.
3133 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
3134 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
3135 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
3136
3137 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3138 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3139 with the usual backslash ('\').
3140 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
3141 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
3142 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
3143 used upper or lower case.
3144
3145
3146 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
3147
3148 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
3149 A health check response will be considered valid if the
3150 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
3151 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3152 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3153 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
3154 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
3155 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
3156
3157 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
3158 A health check response will be considered valid if the
3159 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
3160 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3161 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
3162 expression.
3163
3164 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
3165 in the response buffer. A health check response will
3166 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
3167 this exact hexadecimal string.
3168 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
3169
3170 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3171 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3172 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3173 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
3174 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3175 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3176 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3177 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
3178 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
3179 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
3180 the null character.
3181
3182 Examples :
3183 # perform a POP check
3184 option tcp-check
3185 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
3186
3187 # perform an IMAP check
3188 option tcp-check
3189 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
3190
3191 # look for the redis master server
3192 option tcp-check
3193 tcp-check send PING\r\n
3194 tcp-check expect +PONG
3195 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3196 tcp-check expect string role:master
3197 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
3198 tcp-check expect string +OK
3199
3200
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01003201 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
3202 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003203
3204
3205tcp-check send <data>
3206 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3207 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3208 no | no | yes | yes
3209
3210 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3211 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3212
3213 Examples :
3214 # look for the redis master server
3215 option tcp-check
3216 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3217 tcp-check expect string role:master
3218
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01003219 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
3220 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003221
3222
3223tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
3224 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
3225 tcp health check
3226 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3227 no | no | yes | yes
3228
3229 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3230 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3231 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
3232 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
3233 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
3234 hexadecimal string.
3235 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
3236
3237 Examples :
3238 # redis check in binary
3239 option tcp-check
3240 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
3241 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
3242
3243
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01003244 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
3245 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003246
3247
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003248http-send-name-header [<header>]
3249 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3250
3251 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3252 yes | no | yes | yes
3253
3254 Arguments :
3255
3256 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3257
3258 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3259 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3260 is added with the header string proved.
3261
3262 See also : "server"
3263
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003264id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003265 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3267 no | yes | yes | yes
3268 Arguments : none
3269
3270 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3271 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3272 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003273
3274
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003275ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3276 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3277 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3278 no | yes | yes | yes
3279
3280 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3281 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3282 and running).
3283
3284 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3285 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3286 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003287 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003288 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3289
3290 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3291 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3292
3293 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3294 "unless" condition is met.
3295
3296 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3297
3298
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003299log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003300log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003301no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003302 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3304 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003305
3306 Prefix :
3307 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3308 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3309 prefix does not allow arguments.
3310
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003311 Arguments :
3312 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3313 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3314 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3315 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3316 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3317 parameter.
3318
3319 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3320 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3321
3322 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3323 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3324 standard syslog port).
3325
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003326 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3327 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3328 standard syslog port).
3329
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003330 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3331 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3332 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3333 appropriately writeable).
3334
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003335 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3336 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3337 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3338 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3339
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003340 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3341
3342 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3343 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3344 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3345
3346 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3347 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3348 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003349 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3350 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3351 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3352 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3353 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003354
3355 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3356
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003357 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3358 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3359 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003360
3361 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3362 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3363 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3364 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3365
3366 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3367 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003368
3369 Example :
3370 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003371 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3372 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003373 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3374
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003375
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003376log-format <string>
3377 Allows you to custom a log line.
3378
3379 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3380
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003381
3382maxconn <conns>
3383 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3385 yes | yes | yes | no
3386 Arguments :
3387 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3388 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3389 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3390 closes.
3391
3392 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3393 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3394 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3395 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3396 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3397 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3398 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3399 properly tuned.
3400
3401 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3402 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3403 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3404
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003405 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3406
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003407 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3408
3409
3410mode { tcp|http|health }
3411 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3413 yes | yes | yes | yes
3414 Arguments :
3415 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3416 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3417 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3418 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3419
3420 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3421 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3422 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3423 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3424 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3425
3426 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003427 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3428 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3429 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3430 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3431 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3432 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3433 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003434
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003435 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3436 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3437 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003438
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003439 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003440 defaults http_instances
3441 mode http
3442
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003443 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003444
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003445
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003446monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003447 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3449 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003450 Arguments :
3451 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3452 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003453 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003454 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3455 backend and its backup.
3456
3457 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3458 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3459 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3460 servers in a list of backends.
3461
3462 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3463 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3464 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3465 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3466 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3467 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3468 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003469 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3470 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003471
3472 Example:
3473 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003474 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003475 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3476 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3477 monitor-uri /site_alive
3478 monitor fail if site_dead
3479
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003480 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003481
3482
3483monitor-net <source>
3484 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3486 yes | yes | yes | no
3487 Arguments :
3488 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3489 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3490 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3491 followed by a mask.
3492
3493 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3494 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003495 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003496 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3497
3498 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3499 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3500 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3501 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003502 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3503 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3504 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003505
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003506 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3507 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3508 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3509 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3510 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3511 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003512
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003513 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3514 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003515
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003516 Example :
3517 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3518 frontend www
3519 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3520
3521 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3522
3523
3524monitor-uri <uri>
3525 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3527 yes | yes | yes | no
3528 Arguments :
3529 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3530 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3531
3532 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3533 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3534 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3535 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3536 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3537 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3538 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3539 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3540
3541 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3542 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3543 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3544 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3545 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3546 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3547
3548 Example :
3549 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3550 frontend www
3551 mode http
3552 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3553
3554 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3555
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003556
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003557option abortonclose
3558no option abortonclose
3559 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3561 yes | no | yes | yes
3562 Arguments : none
3563
3564 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3565 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3566 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3567 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003568 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003569 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3570 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3571 encountered while delivering the response.
3572
3573 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3574 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3575 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3576 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3577 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3578 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003579 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003580 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003581 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003582 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3583 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3584 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3585
3586 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3587 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3588 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3589 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3590 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3591 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3592 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3593 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003594 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003595
3596 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3597 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3598
3599 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3600
3601
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003602option accept-invalid-http-request
3603no option accept-invalid-http-request
3604 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3606 yes | yes | yes | no
3607 Arguments : none
3608
3609 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3610 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3611 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3612 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3613 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3614 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3615 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3616 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003617 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3618 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3619 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3620 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3621 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3622 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003623
3624 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3625 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3626 been confirmed.
3627
3628 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3629 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003630 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3631 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003632 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3633
3634 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3635 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3636
3637 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3638 stats socket.
3639
3640
3641option accept-invalid-http-response
3642no option accept-invalid-http-response
3643 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3645 yes | no | yes | yes
3646 Arguments : none
3647
3648 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3649 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3650 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3651 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3652 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3653 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3654 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3655 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3656 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3657
3658 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3659 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3660 been confirmed.
3661
3662 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3663 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3664 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3665 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3666
3667 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3668 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3669
3670 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3671 stats socket.
3672
3673
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003674option allbackups
3675no option allbackups
3676 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3678 yes | no | yes | yes
3679 Arguments : none
3680
3681 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3682 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3683 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3684 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3685 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3686 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3687 order between the backup servers anymore.
3688
3689 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3690 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3691
3692 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3693 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3694
3695
3696option checkcache
3697no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003698 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3700 yes | no | yes | yes
3701 Arguments : none
3702
3703 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3704 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003705 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003706 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3707 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003708 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003709
3710 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003711 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003712 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003713 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3714 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003715 to the client are :
3716 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003717 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003718 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003719 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3720 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3721 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3722 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3723 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3724 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3725 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3726 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3727 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3728 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3729 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3730
3731 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003732 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003733 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003734 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003735 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3736
3737 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3738 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003739 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003740 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3741
3742 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3743 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3744
3745
3746option clitcpka
3747no option clitcpka
3748 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3750 yes | yes | yes | no
3751 Arguments : none
3752
3753 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3754 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3755 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3756 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3757
3758 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3759 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3760 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3761 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3762
3763 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3764 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3765 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3766 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3767 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3768
3769 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3770
3771 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3772 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3773 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3774
3775 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3776 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3777
3778 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3779
3780
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003781option contstats
3782 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3784 yes | yes | yes | no
3785 Arguments : none
3786
3787 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3788 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3789 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3790 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3791 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3792 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3793 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3794
3795
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003796option dontlog-normal
3797no option dontlog-normal
3798 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3800 yes | yes | yes | no
3801 Arguments : none
3802
3803 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3804 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3805 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3806 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3807 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3808 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3809 logged.
3810
3811 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3812 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3813 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003815 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003816 logging.
3817
3818
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003819option dontlognull
3820no option dontlognull
3821 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3823 yes | yes | yes | no
3824 Arguments : none
3825
3826 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3827 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3828 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3829 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3830 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3831 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3832 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3833
3834 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3835 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3836 would not be logged.
3837
3838 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3839 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3840
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003841 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003842
3843
3844option forceclose
3845no option forceclose
3846 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003848 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003849 Arguments : none
3850
3851 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3852 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3853 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3854 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3855 global session times in the logs.
3856
3857 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003858 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003859 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003860
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003861 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3862 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3863 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3864
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003865 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3866 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003867
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003868 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3869 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3870
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003871 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003872
3873
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003874option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003875 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3877 yes | yes | yes | yes
3878 Arguments :
3879 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3880 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003881 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003882 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003883
3884 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3885 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3886 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3887 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3888 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3889 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3890 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003891 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3892 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3893 possible that the client has already brought one.
3894
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003895 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003896 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003897 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3898 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003899 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3900 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003901
3902 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3903 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3904 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3905 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3906 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3907 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3908 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3909
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003910 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3911 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3912 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3913 are under the control of the end-user.
3914
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003915 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003916 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3917 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003918 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3919 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3920 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003921
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003922 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003923 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3924 frontend www
3925 mode http
3926 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3927
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003928 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3929 backend www
3930 mode http
3931 option forwardfor header X-Client
3932
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003933 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003934 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003935
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003936
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003937option http-keep-alive
3938no option http-keep-alive
3939 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
3940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3941 yes | yes | yes | yes
3942 Arguments : none
3943
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003944 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
3945 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
3946 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
3947 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
3948 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
3949 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
3950 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
3951
3952 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
3953 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003954 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
3955 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
3956 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
3957 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
3958 situations where this option may be useful :
3959
3960 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
3961 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
3962
3963 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
3964 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
3965
3966 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
3967 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
3968 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
3969 request.
3970
3971 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
3972 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003973 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
3974 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
3975 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003976
3977 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
3978 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
3979
3980 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3981 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3982 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3983 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
3984 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3985 not set.
3986
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003987 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3988 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003989 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003990 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003991
3992 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003993 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3994 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003995
3996
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003997option http-no-delay
3998no option http-no-delay
3999 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4001 yes | yes | yes | yes
4002 Arguments : none
4003
4004 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4005 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4006 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4007 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4008 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4009 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4010 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4011 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4012 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4013 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4014 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4015 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4016 affected.
4017
4018 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4019 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4020 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4021 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4022 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4023 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4024 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4025 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4026 latency environments.
4027
4028
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004029option http-pretend-keepalive
4030no option http-pretend-keepalive
4031 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4033 yes | yes | yes | yes
4034 Arguments : none
4035
4036 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4037 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4038 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4039 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4040 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4041 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4042 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4043 consider the response complete.
4044
4045 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4046 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4047 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4048 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4049 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4050 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4051
4052 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4053 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4054 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4055 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4056 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4057 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4058 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4059
4060 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4061 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004062 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004063 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4064 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004065
4066 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4067 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4068
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004069 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4070 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004071
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004072
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004073option http-server-close
4074no option http-server-close
4075 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4077 yes | yes | yes | yes
4078 Arguments : none
4079
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004080 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4081 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4082 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4083 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4084 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4085 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4086 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4087 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4088 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4089 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4090 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4091 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4092 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4093 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4094 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4095 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004096
4097 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4098 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4099 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4100 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004101 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4102 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004103
4104 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4105 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004106 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4107 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004108 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4109 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004110
4111 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4112 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4113
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004114 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004115 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4116 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004117
4118
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004119option http-tunnel
4120no option http-tunnel
4121 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4123 yes | yes | yes | yes
4124 Arguments : none
4125
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004126 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4127 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4128 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4129 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4130 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4131 "option http-tunnel".
4132
4133 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004134 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004135 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4136 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4137 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4138 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4139 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4140 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4141 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004142
4143 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4144 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4145
4146 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4147 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4148 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4149
4150
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004151option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004152no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004153 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4155 yes | yes | yes | no
4156 Arguments : none
4157
4158 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4159 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4160 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4161 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4162 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4163 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4164 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4165
4166 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4167 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4168 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4169 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4170 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4171 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4172 request along its whole life.
4173
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004174 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4175 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4176 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4177 front of an existing proxy.
4178
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004179 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4180
4181 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4182 http-server-close".
4183
4184
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004185option httpchk
4186option httpchk <uri>
4187option httpchk <method> <uri>
4188option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4189 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4191 yes | no | yes | yes
4192 Arguments :
4193 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4194 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4195 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4196 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4197 ones.
4198
4199 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4200 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4201 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4202
4203 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4204 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4205 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4206 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4207 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4208
4209 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4210 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4211 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4212 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4213 the lack of any response.
4214
4215 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4216
4217 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4218 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4219 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4220
4221 Examples :
4222 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4223 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4224 backend https_relay
4225 mode tcp
4226 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4227 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4228
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004229 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4230 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4231 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004232
4233
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004234option httpclose
4235no option httpclose
4236 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4238 yes | yes | yes | yes
4239 Arguments : none
4240
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004241 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4242 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4243 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4244 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004245 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004246 "option http-tunnel".
4247
4248 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4249 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4250 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4251 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4252 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4253 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4254 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4255 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004256
4257 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004258 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004259 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4260 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4261 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4262 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4263 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004264
4265 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4266 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004267 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4268 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004269 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4270 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004271
4272 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4273 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4274
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004275 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4276 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004277
4278
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004279option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004280 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4282 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004283 Arguments :
4284 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4285 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4286 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4287 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4288 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004289
4290 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4291 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4292 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4293 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4294 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4295 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4296 ports.
4297
4298 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4299
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004300 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4301 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4302 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4303 by default.
4304
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004305 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004306
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004307
4308option http_proxy
4309no option http_proxy
4310 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4312 yes | yes | yes | yes
4313 Arguments : none
4314
4315 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4316 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4317 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4318 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4319 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4320
4321 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4322 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4323 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4324 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004325 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004326 be analyzed.
4327
4328 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4329 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4330
4331 Example :
4332 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4333 backend direct_forward
4334 option httpclose
4335 option http_proxy
4336
4337 See also : "option httpclose"
4338
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004339
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004340option independent-streams
4341no option independent-streams
4342 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4344 yes | yes | yes | yes
4345 Arguments : none
4346
4347 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4348 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4349 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4350 receive data or not.
4351
4352 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4353 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4354 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4355 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4356 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4357 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4358 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4359 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4360 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4361 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4362 socket buffers.
4363
4364 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4365 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4366 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4367 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4368 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4369
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004370 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004371 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4372 deprecated.
4373
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004374 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004375
4376
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004377option ldap-check
4378 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4380 yes | no | yes | yes
4381 Arguments : none
4382
4383 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4384 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4385 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4386 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4387
4388 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4389 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4390
4391 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4392 configure it.
4393
4394 Example :
4395 option ldap-check
4396
4397 See also : "option httpchk"
4398
4399
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004400option log-health-checks
4401no option log-health-checks
4402 Enable or disable logging of health checks
4403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4404 yes | no | yes | yes
4405 Arguments : none
4406
4407 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
4408 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
4409 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
4410 of additional information is limited.
4411
4412 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
4413 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
4414
4415 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
4416
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004417
4418option log-separate-errors
4419no option log-separate-errors
4420 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4422 yes | yes | yes | no
4423 Arguments : none
4424
4425 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4426 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4427 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4428 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4429 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4430 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4431 provides very important information.
4432
4433 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4434 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4435 error logs.
4436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004437 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004438 logging.
4439
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004440
4441option logasap
4442no option logasap
4443 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4445 yes | yes | yes | no
4446 Arguments : none
4447
4448 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4449 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4450 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4451 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4452 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4453 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4454 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004455 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004456 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4457 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4458
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004459 Examples :
4460 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4461 mode http
4462 option httplog
4463 option logasap
4464 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4465
4466 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4467 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4468 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4469 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4470
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004471 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004472 logging.
4473
4474
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004475option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4476 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4478 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004479 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004480 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4481 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004482
4483 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4484 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4485 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4486 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4487 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4488 in the MySQL table, like this :
4489
4490 USE mysql;
4491 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4492 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4493
4494 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4495 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4496 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4497 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4498 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4499 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4500 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4501 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4502 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4503
4504 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4505 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004506
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004507 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004508
4509 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4510 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4511 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4512 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4513 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4514 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4515
4516 See also: "option httpchk"
4517
4518
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004519option nolinger
4520no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004521 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004522 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4523 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004524 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004525
4526 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4527 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4528 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4529 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4530 connections.
4531
4532 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4533 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4534 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4535 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4536 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4537 this too.
4538
4539 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4540 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4541 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4542
4543 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4544 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4545 for servers.
4546
4547 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4548 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4549
4550
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004551option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4552 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4554 yes | yes | yes | yes
4555 Arguments :
4556 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4557 matching <network>
4558 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4559 header name.
4560
4561 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4562 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4563 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4564 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4565 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4566 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4567 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4568 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4569 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4570 possible that the client has already brought one.
4571
4572 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4573 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4574 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4575 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4576 header and requires different one.
4577
4578 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4579 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4580 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4581 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4582 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4583 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4584 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4585
4586 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4587 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4588 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4589 both are defined.
4590
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004591 Examples :
4592 # Original Destination address
4593 frontend www
4594 mode http
4595 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4596
4597 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4598 backend www
4599 mode http
4600 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4601
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004602 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4603 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004604
4605
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004606option persist
4607no option persist
4608 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4609 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4610 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004611 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004612
4613 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4614 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4615 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4616 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4617 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4618 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4619 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4620 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4621 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4622 redirected to another valid server.
4623
4624 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4625 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4626
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004627 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004628
4629
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004630option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4631 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4633 yes | no | yes | yes
4634 Arguments :
4635 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4636 PostgreSQL server.
4637
4638 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4639 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4640 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4641 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4642
4643 See also: "option httpchk"
4644
4645
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004646option prefer-last-server
4647no option prefer-last-server
4648 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4649 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4650 yes | no | yes | yes
4651 Arguments : none
4652
4653 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4654 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4655 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4656 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4657 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4658 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4659 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4660 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4661 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004662 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4663 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4664 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4665 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4666 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4667 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4668 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004669
4670 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4671 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4672
4673 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4674
4675
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004676option redispatch
4677no option redispatch
4678 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4679 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4680 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004681 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004682
4683 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4684 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4685 be able to access the service anymore.
4686
4687 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4688 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4689
4690 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4691 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4692 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004693
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004694 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4695 "redisp" keywords.
4696
4697 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4698 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4699
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004700 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004701
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004702
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004703option redis-check
4704 Use redis health checks for server testing
4705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4706 yes | no | yes | yes
4707 Arguments : none
4708
4709 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4710 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4711 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4712 find the "+PONG" response message.
4713
4714 Example :
4715 option redis-check
4716
4717 See also : "option httpchk"
4718
4719
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004720option smtpchk
4721option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4722 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4724 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004725 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004726 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4727 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4728 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4729
4730 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4731 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4732 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4733
4734 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4735 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4736 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4737 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4738 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4739 dead server.
4740
4741 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4742 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4743 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4744 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4745
4746 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4747 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4748 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4749 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4750 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4751
4752 Example :
4753 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4754
4755 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4756
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004757
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004758option socket-stats
4759no option socket-stats
4760
4761 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4763 yes | yes | yes | no
4764
4765 Arguments : none
4766
4767
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004768option splice-auto
4769no option splice-auto
4770 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4772 yes | yes | yes | yes
4773 Arguments : none
4774
4775 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4776 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4777 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4778 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004779 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004780 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4781 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4782 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4783 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4784
4785 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4786 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4787 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4788 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4789 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4790 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4791 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4792 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4793 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4794 keyword.
4795
4796 Example :
4797 option splice-auto
4798
4799 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4800 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4801
4802 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4803 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4804
4805
4806option splice-request
4807no option splice-request
4808 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4810 yes | yes | yes | yes
4811 Arguments : none
4812
4813 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004814 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004815 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4816 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4817 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4818 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4819
4820 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4821
4822 Example :
4823 option splice-request
4824
4825 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4826 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4827
4828 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4829 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4830
4831
4832option splice-response
4833no option splice-response
4834 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4836 yes | yes | yes | yes
4837 Arguments : none
4838
4839 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004840 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004841 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4842 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4843 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4844 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4845
4846 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4847
4848 Example :
4849 option splice-response
4850
4851 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4852 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4853
4854 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4855 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4856
4857
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004858option srvtcpka
4859no option srvtcpka
4860 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4862 yes | no | yes | yes
4863 Arguments : none
4864
4865 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4866 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4867 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4868 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4869
4870 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4871 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4872 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4873 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4874
4875 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4876 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4877 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4878 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4879 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4880
4881 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4882
4883 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4884 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4885 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4886
4887 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4888 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4889
4890 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4891
4892
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004893option ssl-hello-chk
4894 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4896 yes | no | yes | yes
4897 Arguments : none
4898
4899 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4900 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4901 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4902 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4903 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4904 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4905 hello message.
4906
4907 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4908 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4909 messages, which is appreciable.
4910
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004911 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4912 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4913 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004914
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004915 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4916
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004917
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004918option tcp-check
4919 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
4920 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4921 yes | no | yes | yes
4922
4923 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
4924 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
4925
4926 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
4927 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
4928 attempt, which remains the default mode.
4929
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004930 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004931 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
4932 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
4933 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
4934 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
4935 only.
4936
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004937 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004938 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
4939 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
4940 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
4941 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
4942
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004943 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004944 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
4945 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004946 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004947 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
4948 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
4949 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
4950 the respective protocols.
4951 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
4952 analysed.
4953
4954 Examples :
4955 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
4956 option tcp-check
4957 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
4958
4959 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
4960 option tcp-check
4961 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
4962
4963 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
4964 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004965 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004966 option tcp-check
4967 tcp-check send PING\r\n
4968 tcp-check expect +PONG
4969 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
4970 tcp-check expect string role:master
4971 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
4972 tcp-check expect string +OK
4973
4974 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
4975 (send many headers before analyzing)
4976 option tcp-check
4977 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
4978 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
4979 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
4980 tcp-check send \r\n
4981 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
4982
4983
4984 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
4985
4986
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004987option tcp-smart-accept
4988no option tcp-smart-accept
4989 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4991 yes | yes | yes | no
4992 Arguments : none
4993
4994 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4995 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4996 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4997 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4998 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4999 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5000
5001 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5002 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5003 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5004 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5005
5006 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5007 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5008 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5009 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5010
5011 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5012 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5013 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5014
5015 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5016 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5017 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5018
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005019 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5020
5021
5022option tcp-smart-connect
5023no option tcp-smart-connect
5024 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5026 yes | no | yes | yes
5027 Arguments : none
5028
5029 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5030 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5031 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5032 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5033 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5034
5035 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5036 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5037 complex.
5038
5039 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5040 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5041 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5042
5043 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5044 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5045
5046 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5047
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005048
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005049option tcpka
5050 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5052 yes | yes | yes | yes
5053 Arguments : none
5054
5055 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5056 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5057 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5058 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5059
5060 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5061 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5062 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5063 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5064
5065 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5066 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5067 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5068 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5069 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5070
5071 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5072
5073 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5074 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5075 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5076 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5077 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5078 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5079 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5080 backends.
5081
5082 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5083
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005084
5085option tcplog
5086 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5088 yes | yes | yes | yes
5089 Arguments : none
5090
5091 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5092 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5093 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5094 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5095 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5096 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5097 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5098 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5099
5100 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5101
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005102 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005103
5104
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005105option transparent
5106no option transparent
5107 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005109 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005110 Arguments : none
5111
5112 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5113 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5114 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5115 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5116 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5117 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5118 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5119 appropriate server.
5120
5121 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5122 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5123
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005124 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005125 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005126
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005127
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005128persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005129persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005130 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5132 yes | no | yes | yes
5133 Arguments :
5134 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005135 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5136 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005137
5138 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5139 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5140 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5141 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5142 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5143 forwarded to this server.
5144
5145 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5146 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5147 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005148 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005149 a single "listen" section.
5150
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005151 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5152 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5153 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5154
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005155 Example :
5156 listen tse-farm
5157 bind :3389
5158 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5159 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5160 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5161 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5162 persist rdp-cookie
5163 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005164 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005165 balance rdp-cookie
5166 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5167 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5168
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005169 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5170 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005171
5172
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005173rate-limit sessions <rate>
5174 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5176 yes | yes | yes | no
5177 Arguments :
5178 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5179 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5180
5181 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5182 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5183 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5184 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5185 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5186 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5187
5188 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5189 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5190 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5191 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5192
5193 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5194 listen smtp
5195 mode tcp
5196 bind :25
5197 rate-limit sessions 10
5198 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5199
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005200 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5201 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5202 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005203
5204 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5205
5206
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005207redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5208redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5209redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005210 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5212 no | yes | yes | yes
5213
5214 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005215 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005216
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005217 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005218 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005219 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5220 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5221 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005222
5223 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5224 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5225 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5226 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5227 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005228 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5229 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5230 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5231 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005232
5233 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5234 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5235 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5236 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5237 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5238 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005239 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005240 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005241 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5242 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5243 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005244
5245 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005246 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5247 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5248 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5249 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5250 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5251 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5252 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5253 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005254
5255 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5256 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5257
5258 - "drop-query"
5259 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5260 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5261 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5262 with a location-type redirect.
5263
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005264 - "append-slash"
5265 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5266 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5267 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5268 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5269
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005270 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5271 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5272 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5273 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5274 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5275 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5276 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5277
5278 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5279 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5280 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5281 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5282 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5283 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5284 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005285
5286 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5287 acl clear dst_port 80
5288 acl secure dst_port 8080
5289 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005290 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005291 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005292 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5293
5294 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005295 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5296 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5297 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005298 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005299
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005300 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5301 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5302 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5303
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005304 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005305 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005306
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005307 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5308 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5309 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5310
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005311 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005312
5313
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005314redisp (deprecated)
5315redispatch (deprecated)
5316 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5317 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5318 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005319 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005320
5321 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5322 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5323 be able to access the service anymore.
5324
5325 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5326 redistribute them to a working server.
5327
5328 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5329 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5330 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005331
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005332 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5333 "option redispatch" instead.
5334
5335 See also : "option redispatch"
5336
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005337
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005338reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005339 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5341 no | yes | yes | yes
5342 Arguments :
5343 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5344 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005345 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005346
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005347 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5348 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5349
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005350 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5351 the last header of an HTTP request.
5352
5353 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5354 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5355 responses.
5356
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005357 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5358 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5359 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5360
5361 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5362 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005363
5364
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005365reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5366reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005367 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5369 no | yes | yes | yes
5370 Arguments :
5371 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5372 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5373 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5374 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5375 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5376 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5377 ignores case.
5378
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005379 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5380 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5381
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005382 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5383 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5384 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5385 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005386 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005387
5388 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5389 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5390
5391 Example :
5392 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5393 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5394 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5395
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005396 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5397 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005398
5399
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005400reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5401reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005402 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5404 no | yes | yes | yes
5405 Arguments :
5406 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5407 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5408 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5409 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5410 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5411 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5412
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005413 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5414 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5415
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005416 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5417 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5418 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5419 next servers.
5420
5421 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5422 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5423 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5424
5425 Example :
5426 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5427 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5428 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5429
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005430 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5431 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005432
5433
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005434reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5435reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005436 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5438 no | yes | yes | yes
5439 Arguments :
5440 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5441 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5442 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5443 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5444 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5445 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5446 case.
5447
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005448 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5449 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5450
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005451 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5452 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5453 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5454 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005455 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005456
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005457 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005458 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005459 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005460
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005461 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5462 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5463
5464 Example :
5465 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5466 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5467 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5468
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005469 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5470 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005471
5472
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005473reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5474reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005475 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5477 no | yes | yes | yes
5478 Arguments :
5479 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5480 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5481 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5482 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5483 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5484 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5485 case.
5486
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005487 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5488 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5489
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005490 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5491 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5492 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5493 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5494
5495 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5496 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5497
5498 Example :
5499 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5500 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5501 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5502 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5503
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005504 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5505 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005506
5507
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005508reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5509reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005510 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5512 no | yes | yes | yes
5513 Arguments :
5514 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5515 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5516 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5517 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5518 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5519 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5520
5521 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5522 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5523 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5524 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005525 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005526
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005527 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5528 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5529
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005530 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5531 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5532 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5533
5534 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5535 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5536 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5537 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5538 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5539
5540 Example :
5541 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005542 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005543 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5544 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5545
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005546 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5547 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005548
5549
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005550reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5551reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005552 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5554 no | yes | yes | yes
5555 Arguments :
5556 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5557 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5558 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5559 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5560 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5561 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5562 ignores case.
5563
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005564 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5565 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5566
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005567 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5568 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005569 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5570 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5571 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005572 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5573 not set.
5574
5575 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5576 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5577 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5578 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5579 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5580
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005581 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005582 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5583 # block all others.
5584 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5585 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5586
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005587 # block bad guys
5588 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5589 reqitarpit . if badguys
5590
5591 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5592 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005593
5594
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005595retries <value>
5596 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5597 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5598 yes | no | yes | yes
5599 Arguments :
5600 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5601 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5602 default value is 3.
5603
5604 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5605 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5606 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5607
5608 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5609 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5610
5611 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5612 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5613
5614 See also : "option redispatch"
5615
5616
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005617rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005618 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5620 no | yes | yes | yes
5621 Arguments :
5622 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5623 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005624 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005625
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005626 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5627 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5628
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005629 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5630 the last header of an HTTP response.
5631
5632 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5633 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5634 responses.
5635
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005636 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5637 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005638
5639
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005640rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5641rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005642 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5644 no | yes | yes | yes
5645 Arguments :
5646 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5647 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5648 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5649 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5650 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5651 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5652 ignores case.
5653
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005654 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5655 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5656
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005657 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5658 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005659 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005660 client.
5661
5662 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5663 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5664 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5665
5666 Example :
5667 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005668 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005669
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005670 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5671 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005672
5673
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005674rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5675rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005676 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5678 no | yes | yes | yes
5679 Arguments :
5680 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5681 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5682 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5683 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5684 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5685 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5686 ignores case.
5687
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005688 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5689 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5690
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005691 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5692 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5693 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5694 case-sensitive.
5695
5696 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005697 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5698 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5699 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005700
5701 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5702 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5703
5704 Example :
5705 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5706 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5707
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005708 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5709 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005710
5711
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005712rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5713rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005714 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5716 no | yes | yes | yes
5717 Arguments :
5718 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5719 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5720 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5721 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5722 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5723 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5724 ignores case.
5725
5726 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5727 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5728 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5729 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005730 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005731
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005732 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5733 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5734
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005735 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5736 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5737 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5738
5739 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5740 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5741 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5742 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5743 are not case-sensitive.
5744
5745 Example :
5746 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5747 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5748
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005749 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5750 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005751
5752
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005753server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005754 Declare a server in a backend
5755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5756 no | no | yes | yes
5757 Arguments :
5758 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005759 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005760 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005761
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005762 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5763 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5764 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5765 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005766 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5767 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5768 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5769 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5770 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005771 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5772 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5773 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5774 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5775 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5776 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5777 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005778 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5779 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5780 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5781 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005782
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005783 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005784 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5785 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5786 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5787 adding this value to the client's port.
5788
5789 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5790 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005791 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005792
5793 Examples :
5794 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5795 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005796 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005797 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5798 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5799 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005800
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005801 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5802 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005803
5804
5805source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005806source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005807source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005808 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5810 yes | no | yes | yes
5811 Arguments :
5812 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5813 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005814
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005815 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005816 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5817 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5818 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5819 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5820 supported prefixes are :
5821 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5822 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5823 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005824 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5825 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5826 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5827 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005828
5829 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5830 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005831 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5832 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5833 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005834
5835 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5836 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5837 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5838 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5839 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5840 <addr>.
5841
5842 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5843 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5844 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5845 port.
5846
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005847 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5848 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5849 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5850 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005851 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005852 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5853 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5854 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5855 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5856 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5857 HTTP header.
5858
5859 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5860 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005861 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005862 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5863 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5864 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5865 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5866 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5867 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5868 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5869
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005870 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5871 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5872 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5873 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5874 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5875 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5876
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005877 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5878 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5879 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5880 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5881
5882 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5883 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5884 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5885 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5886 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5887 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5888
5889 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5890 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5891 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5892 there are two methods :
5893
5894 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5895 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5896 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5897 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5898 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5899 of the client ranges may be used.
5900
5901 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5902 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5903 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5904 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5905 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5906 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5907 same session.
5908
5909 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5910 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5911 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5912 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5913 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5914 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5915
5916 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5917 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5918 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005919 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005920
5921 Examples :
5922 backend private
5923 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5924 source 192.168.1.200
5925
5926 backend transparent_ssl1
5927 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5928 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5929
5930 backend transparent_ssl2
5931 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5932 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5933 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5934
5935 backend transparent_ssl3
5936 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5937 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5938 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5939
5940 backend transparent_smtp
5941 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5942 # with Tproxy version 4.
5943 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5944
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005945 backend transparent_http
5946 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5947 # proxy.
5948 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5949
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005950 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005951 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5952
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005953
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005954srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5955 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5957 yes | no | yes | yes
5958 Arguments :
5959 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5960 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5961 as explained at the top of this document.
5962
5963 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5964 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5965 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5966 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5967 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5968 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5969 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5970
5971 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5972 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5973 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5974 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5975 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005976 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005977 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005978 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005979
5980 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5981 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5982 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5983 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5984 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5985 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5986
5987 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5988 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5989
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005990 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5991 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005992
5993
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005994stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5995 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02005997 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005998
5999 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6000 matched.
6001
6002 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6003 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6004
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006005 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6006 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6007 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6008
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006009 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6010 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6011 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6012 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006013
6014 Example :
6015 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6016 backend stats_localhost
6017 stats enable
6018 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6019
6020 Example :
6021 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6022 backend stats_auth
6023 stats enable
6024 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6025 stats admin if TRUE
6026
6027 Example :
6028 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6029 userlist stats-auth
6030 group admin users admin
6031 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6032 group readonly users haproxy
6033 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6034
6035 backend stats_auth
6036 stats enable
6037 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6038 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6039 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6040 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6041
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006042 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6043 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6044 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006045
6046
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006047stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6048 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006050 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006051 Arguments :
6052 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6053
6054 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6055
6056 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6057 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6058 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6059 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6060 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6061 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6062
6063 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6064 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6065 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006066 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006067
6068 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6069 report using "stats scope".
6070
6071 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6072 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6073 unobvious parameters.
6074
6075 Example :
6076 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6077 backend public_www
6078 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6079 stats enable
6080 stats hide-version
6081 stats scope .
6082 stats uri /admin?stats
6083 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6084 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6085 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6086
6087 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6088 backend private_monitoring
6089 stats enable
6090 stats uri /admin?stats
6091 stats refresh 5s
6092
6093 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6094
6095
6096stats enable
6097 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006099 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006100 Arguments : none
6101
6102 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6103 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6104 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6105 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6106 - stats auth : no authentication
6107 - stats scope : no restriction
6108
6109 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6110 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6111 unobvious parameters.
6112
6113 Example :
6114 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6115 backend public_www
6116 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6117 stats enable
6118 stats hide-version
6119 stats scope .
6120 stats uri /admin?stats
6121 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6122 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6123 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6124
6125 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6126 backend private_monitoring
6127 stats enable
6128 stats uri /admin?stats
6129 stats refresh 5s
6130
6131 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6132
6133
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006134stats hide-version
6135 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006137 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006138 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006139
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006140 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6141 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6142 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6143 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6144 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6145 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006146
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006147 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6148 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6149 unobvious parameters.
6150
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006151 Example :
6152 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6153 backend public_www
6154 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006155 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006156 stats hide-version
6157 stats scope .
6158 stats uri /admin?stats
6159 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6160 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6161 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006162
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006163 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6164 backend private_monitoring
6165 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006166 stats uri /admin?stats
6167 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006168
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006169 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006170
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006171
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006172stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6173 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6174 Access control for statistics
6175
6176 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6177 no | no | yes | yes
6178
6179 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6180 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6181 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6182 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6183 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6184 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6185
6186 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6187 instance.
6188
6189 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6190 about ACL usage.
6191
6192
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006193stats realm <realm>
6194 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006196 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006197 Arguments :
6198 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6199 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6200 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6201
6202 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6203 using a backslash ('\').
6204
6205 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6206 only related to authentication.
6207
6208 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6209 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6210 unobvious parameters.
6211
6212 Example :
6213 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6214 backend public_www
6215 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6216 stats enable
6217 stats hide-version
6218 stats scope .
6219 stats uri /admin?stats
6220 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6221 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6222 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6223
6224 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6225 backend private_monitoring
6226 stats enable
6227 stats uri /admin?stats
6228 stats refresh 5s
6229
6230 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6231
6232
6233stats refresh <delay>
6234 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006236 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006237 Arguments :
6238 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6239 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6240 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6241 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6242 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6243 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6244
6245 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6246 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6247 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6248 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6249
6250 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6251 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6252 unobvious parameters.
6253
6254 Example :
6255 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6256 backend public_www
6257 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6258 stats enable
6259 stats hide-version
6260 stats scope .
6261 stats uri /admin?stats
6262 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6263 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6264 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6265
6266 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6267 backend private_monitoring
6268 stats enable
6269 stats uri /admin?stats
6270 stats refresh 5s
6271
6272 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6273
6274
6275stats scope { <name> | "." }
6276 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006278 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006279 Arguments :
6280 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6281 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6282 section in which the statement appears.
6283
6284 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6285 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6286 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6287 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6288 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6289 exists.
6290
6291 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6292 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6293 unobvious parameters.
6294
6295 Example :
6296 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6297 backend public_www
6298 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6299 stats enable
6300 stats hide-version
6301 stats scope .
6302 stats uri /admin?stats
6303 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6304 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6305 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6306
6307 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6308 backend private_monitoring
6309 stats enable
6310 stats uri /admin?stats
6311 stats refresh 5s
6312
6313 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6314
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006315
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006316stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006317 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006319 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006320
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006321 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006322 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6323
6324 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6325 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6326
6327 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6328 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006329 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006330
6331 Example :
6332 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6333 backend private_monitoring
6334 stats enable
6335 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6336 stats uri /admin?stats
6337 stats refresh 5s
6338
6339 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6340 global section.
6341
6342
6343stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006344 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6346 yes | yes | yes | yes
6347 Arguments : none
6348
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006349 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006350 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6351 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6352 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6353 - IP (socket, server)
6354 - cookie (backend, server)
6355
6356 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6357 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006358 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006359
6360 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6361
6362
6363stats show-node [ <name> ]
6364 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006366 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006367 Arguments:
6368 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6369 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6370
6371 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6372 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006373 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006374
6375 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6376 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6377 unobvious parameters.
6378
6379 Example:
6380 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6381 backend private_monitoring
6382 stats enable
6383 stats show-node Europe-1
6384 stats uri /admin?stats
6385 stats refresh 5s
6386
6387 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6388 section.
6389
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006390
6391stats uri <prefix>
6392 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006394 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006395 Arguments :
6396 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6397 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6398 query string.
6399
6400 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6401 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6402 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6403 possible to reach it in the application.
6404
6405 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006406 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006407 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6408 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6409 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6410 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6411
6412 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6413 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6414 an address or a port to statistics only.
6415
6416 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6417 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6418 unobvious parameters.
6419
6420 Example :
6421 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6422 backend public_www
6423 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6424 stats enable
6425 stats hide-version
6426 stats scope .
6427 stats uri /admin?stats
6428 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6429 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6430 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6431
6432 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6433 backend private_monitoring
6434 stats enable
6435 stats uri /admin?stats
6436 stats refresh 5s
6437
6438 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6439
6440
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006441stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6442 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006444 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006445
6446 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006447 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006448 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6449 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6450 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6451
6452 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6453 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6454 the "stick-table" statement.
6455
6456 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6457 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6458 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6459 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6460 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6461
6462 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6463 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6464 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6465 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6466 transformation rules.
6467
6468 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6469 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6470 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6471 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6472 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6473 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6474 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6475
6476 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6477 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6478 ACL based conditions.
6479
6480 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6481 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6482 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6483 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6484
6485 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6486 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6487 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6488 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6489
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006490 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6491 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6492 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6493
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006494 Example :
6495 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6496 # last 30 minutes
6497 backend pop
6498 mode tcp
6499 balance roundrobin
6500 stick store-request src
6501 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6502 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6503 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6504
6505 backend smtp
6506 mode tcp
6507 balance roundrobin
6508 stick match src table pop
6509 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6510 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6511
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006512 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6513 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006514
6515
6516stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6517 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6519 no | no | yes | yes
6520
6521 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6522 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6523 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6524 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6525
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006526 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6527 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6528 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6529
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006530 Examples :
6531 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006532 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006533
6534 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6535 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6536 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6537
6538
6539 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6540 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6541 backend http
6542 mode http
6543 balance roundrobin
6544 stick on src table https
6545 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6546 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6547 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6548
6549 backend https
6550 mode tcp
6551 balance roundrobin
6552 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6553 stick on src
6554 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6555 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6556
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006557 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006558
6559
6560stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6561 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6563 no | no | yes | yes
6564
6565 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006566 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006567 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6568 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6569 server is selected.
6570
6571 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6572 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6573 the "stick-table" statement.
6574
6575 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6576 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6577 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6578 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6579 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6580 address.
6581
6582 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6583 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6584 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6585 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6586 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6587 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6588 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6589 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6590 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6591 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6592
6593 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6594 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6595 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6596 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6597 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6598 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6599 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6600
6601 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6602 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6603 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6604 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6605
6606 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6607 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6608 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6609 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6610 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6611 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006612 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6613 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6614 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6615 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6616 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6617 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006618
6619 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6620 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6621 the request.
6622
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006623 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6624 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6625 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6626
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006627 Example :
6628 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6629 # last 30 minutes
6630 backend pop
6631 mode tcp
6632 balance roundrobin
6633 stick store-request src
6634 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6635 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6636 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6637
6638 backend smtp
6639 mode tcp
6640 balance roundrobin
6641 stick match src table pop
6642 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6643 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6644
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006645 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6646 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006647
6648
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006649stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006650 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6651 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006652 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006654 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006655
6656 Arguments :
6657 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6658 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6659 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6660 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6661
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006662 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6663 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6664 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6665 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6666
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006667 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6668 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6669 instance.
6670
6671 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6672 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6673 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6674 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6675 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6676 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006677 to 32 characters.
6678
6679 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6680 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6681 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6682 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6683 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6684 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006685
6686 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006687 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6688 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006689 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6690 increase.
6691
6692 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006693 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6694 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6695 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006696
6697 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6698 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6699 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6700 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6701 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6702 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6703 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6704 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6705 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6706 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6707 parameter (see below).
6708
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006709 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6710 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6711 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6712 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6713 soft restart.
6714
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006715 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6716
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006717 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6718 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6719 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6720 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6721 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006722 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006723 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6724 if not expiration delay is specified.
6725
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006726 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6727 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6728 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6729 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006730 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6731 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6732 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6733 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6734 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6735 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6736 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6737 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6738 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6739 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6740 types and their arguments.
6741
6742 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6743 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6744 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6745 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6746
6747 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6748 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6749 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6750 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6751
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006752 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6753 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6754 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6755 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6756 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6757 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6758
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006759 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6760 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6761 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6762 they were received.
6763
6764 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6765 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6766 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6767 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6768 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6769
6770 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6771 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6772 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6773 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6774 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6775
6776 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6777 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6778 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6779
6780 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6781 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6782 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6783 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6784 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6785
6786 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6787 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6788 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6789 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6790 the client side.
6791
6792 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6793 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6794 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6795 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6796 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6797 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6798 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6799
6800 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6801 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6802 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6803 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6804 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6805 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6806 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6807
6808 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6809 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6810 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6811 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6812 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6813 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6814
6815 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6816 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6817 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6818 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6819
6820 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6821 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6822 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6823 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6824 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6825 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6826 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6827 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6828 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6829 recommended for better fairness.
6830
6831 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6832 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6833 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6834 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6835
6836 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6837 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6838 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6839 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6840 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6841 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6842 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6843 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6844 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6845 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006846
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006847 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6848 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006849 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6850 reference it.
6851
6852 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6853 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6854 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6855 as an exclusive stickiness.
6856
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006857 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6858 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6859 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6860 something that can be ignored.
6861
6862 Example:
6863 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6864 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6865 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6866 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6867
6868 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006869 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006870
6871
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006872stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6873 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6875 no | no | yes | yes
6876
6877 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006878 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006879 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6880 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6881 server is selected.
6882
6883 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6884 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6885 the "stick-table" statement.
6886
6887 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6888 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6889 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6890 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6891
6892 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6893 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6894 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6895 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6896 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6897 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006898 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006899 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6900 rules.
6901
6902 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6903 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6904 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6905 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6906 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6907 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6908 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6909
6910 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6911 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6912 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6913 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6914
6915 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6916 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6917 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6918 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6919 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6920 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006921 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
6922 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6923 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6924 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6925 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6926 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
6927 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
6928 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
6929 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006930
6931 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6932
6933 Example :
6934 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6935 backend https
6936 mode tcp
6937 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006938 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006939 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006940
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006941 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6942 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6943
6944 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6945 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6946 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6947
6948 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6949 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006950
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006951 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6952 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6953 # at offset 44.
6954
6955 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6956 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6957
6958 # Learn on response if server hello.
6959 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006960
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006961 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6962 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6963
6964 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6965 extraction.
6966
6967
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006968tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6969 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6971 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006972 Arguments :
6973 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006974 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6975 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006976
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006977 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006978
6979 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6980 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006981 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6982 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6983 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6984 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6985 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6986 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006987
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006988 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6989 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6990 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6991 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006992
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006993 Three types of actions are supported :
6994 - accept :
6995 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6996 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6997 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006998
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006999 - reject :
7000 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7001 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7002 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7003 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7004 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7005 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7006 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7007 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7008 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7009 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7010 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7011 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007012
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007013 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7014 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7015 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7016 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7017 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7018 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7019 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7020 hosts.
7021
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007022 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007023 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7024 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7025 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007026 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7027 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007028 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007029 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7030 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7031 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7032 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7033 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007034
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007035 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007036 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007037 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007038 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7039 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7040 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7041 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007042
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007043 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7044 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7045 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7046 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007047
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007048 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7049 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7050 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7051 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7052 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007053 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7054 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7055 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7056 layer7 information is extracted.
7057
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007058 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7059 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7060 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7061 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7062 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007063
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007064 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7065 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7066 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007067
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007068 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7069 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7070 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007071
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007072 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007073 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007074 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007075
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007076 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7077 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7078 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007079
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007080 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007081 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7082 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007083
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007084 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7085
7086 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7087
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007088 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7089
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007090 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007091
7092
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007093tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7094 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007096 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007097 Arguments :
7098 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007099 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7100 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02007101 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007102
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007103 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007104
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007105 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7106 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7107 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7108 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7109 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007110
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007111 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7112 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7113 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7114 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007115 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7116 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7117 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7118 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7119 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7120 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007121 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007122 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007123
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007124 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7125 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7126 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7127 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007128
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007129 Three types of actions are supported :
7130 - accept :
7131 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007132 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007133
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007134 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7135 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007136
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007137 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7138 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7139 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7140 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7141 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7142 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007143
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007144 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007145 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7146 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007147
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007148 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007149 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7150 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7151 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7152 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007153 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7154 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7155 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007156
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007157 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
7158 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
7159 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
7160 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
7161
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007162 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007163 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7164 # and reject everything else.
7165 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7166 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007167 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007168 tcp-request content reject
7169
7170 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007171 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7172 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7173 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007174 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007175
7176 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7177 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7178 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007179 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007180 tcp-request content reject
7181
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007182 Example:
7183 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7184 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007185 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007186
7187 Example:
7188 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7189 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007190 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007191
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007192 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7193 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7194
7195 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007196 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007197 # protecting all our sites
7198 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007199 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7200 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007201 ...
7202 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7203
7204 backend http_dynamic
7205 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007206 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007207 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007208 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7209 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7210 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007211 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007213 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007214
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007215 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007216
7217
7218tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7219 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007221 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007222 Arguments :
7223 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7224 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7225 as explained at the top of this document.
7226
7227 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7228 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7229 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7230 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7231 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7232
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007233 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7234 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7235 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7236 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7237
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007238 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7239 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007240 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007241 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007242 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7243 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7244 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7245 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007246
7247 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7248 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7249 it pass through unaffected.
7250
7251 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7252 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7253 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007254 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007255 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7256 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007257 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7258 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7259 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007260
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007261 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007262 "timeout client".
7263
7264
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007265tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7266 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7268 no | no | yes | yes
7269 Arguments :
7270 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007271 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007272
7273 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7274
7275 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7276 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7277 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007278 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7279 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007280
7281 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7282
7283 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7284 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7285 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7286 inserted.
7287
7288 Two types of actions are supported :
7289 - accept :
7290 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7291 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7292 the rules evaluation.
7293
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007294 - close :
7295 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7296 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7297 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7298 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7299 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7300 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007301 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007302 protocols.
7303
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007304 - reject :
7305 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7306 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007307 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007308
7309 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7310 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7311 for changing the default action to a reject.
7312
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007313 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7314 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7315 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7316 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007317 period.
7318
7319 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7320
7321 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7322
7323
7324tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7325 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7327 no | no | yes | yes
7328 Arguments :
7329 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7330 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7331 as explained at the top of this document.
7332
7333 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7334
7335
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007336timeout check <timeout>
7337 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7338 established.
7339
7340 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7341 yes | no | yes | yes
7342 Arguments:
7343 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7344 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7345 as explained at the top of this document.
7346
7347 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7348 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7349 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7350 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007351 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7352 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7353 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007354
7355 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7356 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7357
7358 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7359 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007360 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007361
7362 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7363 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7364 forget about it.
7365
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007366 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7367 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007368
7369
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007370timeout client <timeout>
7371timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7372 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7374 yes | yes | yes | no
7375 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007376 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007377 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7378 as explained at the top of this document.
7379
7380 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7381 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7382 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7383 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7384 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7385 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7386 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7387 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007388 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007389 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007390 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7391 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
7392 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007393
7394 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7395 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7396 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7397 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7398 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7399 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7400
7401 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7402 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7403 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7404
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007405 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007406
7407
7408timeout connect <timeout>
7409timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7410 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7412 yes | no | yes | yes
7413 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007414 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007415 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7416 as explained at the top of this document.
7417
7418 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007419 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007420 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007421 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007422 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7423 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007424
7425 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7426 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7427 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7428 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7429 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7430 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7431
7432 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7433 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7434 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7435
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007436 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7437 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007438
7439
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007440timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7441 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7443 yes | yes | yes | yes
7444 Arguments :
7445 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7446 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7447 as explained at the top of this document.
7448
7449 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7450 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7451 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7452 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7453 once the request has started to present itself.
7454
7455 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7456 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7457 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7458 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7459 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7460
7461 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7462 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7463 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7464 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7465
7466 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7467 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7468 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7469 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7470 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007471 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007472
7473 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7474 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7475 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7476 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7477
7478 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7479
7480
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007481timeout http-request <timeout>
7482 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007484 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007485 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007486 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007487 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7488 as explained at the top of this document.
7489
7490 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7491 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7492 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7493 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7494 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7495 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7496 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
7497 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
7498
7499 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7500 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007501 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7502 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007503
7504 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7505 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7506 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7507 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7508 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7509
7510 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007511 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7512 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7513 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007514
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007515 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007516
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007517
7518timeout queue <timeout>
7519 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7521 yes | no | yes | yes
7522 Arguments :
7523 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7524 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7525 as explained at the top of this document.
7526
7527 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7528 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7529 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7530 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7531 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7532
7533 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7534 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7535 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7536 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7537
7538 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7539
7540
7541timeout server <timeout>
7542timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7543 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7545 yes | no | yes | yes
7546 Arguments :
7547 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7548 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7549 as explained at the top of this document.
7550
7551 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7552 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7553 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7554 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7555 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7556 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7557 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7558
7559 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7560 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7561 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7562 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7563 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007564 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007565 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007566 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7567 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7568 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7569 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007570
7571 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7572 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7573 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7574 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7575 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7576 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7577
7578 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7579 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7580 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7581
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007582 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007583
7584
7585timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007586 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7588 yes | yes | yes | yes
7589 Arguments :
7590 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7591 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7592 as explained at the top of this document.
7593
7594 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7595 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7596 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7597
7598 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7599 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7600 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7601 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007602 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007603
7604 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7605
7606
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007607timeout tunnel <timeout>
7608 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7610 yes | no | yes | yes
7611 Arguments :
7612 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7613 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7614 as explained at the top of this document.
7615
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007616 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007617 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7618 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7619 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7620 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7621 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7622 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7623 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7624 specified.
7625
7626 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7627 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7628 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7629 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7630 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7631
7632 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7633 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7634 forget about it.
7635
7636 Example :
7637 defaults http
7638 option http-server-close
7639 timeout connect 5s
7640 timeout client 30s
7641 timeout client 30s
7642 timeout server 30s
7643 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7644
7645 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
7646
7647
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007648transparent (deprecated)
7649 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007651 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007652 Arguments : none
7653
7654 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7655 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7656 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7657 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7658 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7659 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7660 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7661 appropriate server.
7662
7663 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7664
7665 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7666 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7667
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007668 See also: "option transparent"
7669
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007670unique-id-format <string>
7671 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7673 yes | yes | yes | no
7674 Arguments :
7675 <string> is a log-format string.
7676
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007677 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7678 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7679 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7680 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007681
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007682 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7683 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7684 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7685 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7686 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7687 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7688 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7689 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007690
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007691 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7692 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007693
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007694 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007695
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007696 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007697
7698 will generate:
7699
7700 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7701
7702 See also: "unique-id-header"
7703
7704unique-id-header <name>
7705 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7707 yes | yes | yes | no
7708 Arguments :
7709 <name> is the name of the header.
7710
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007711 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7712 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007713
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007714 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007715
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007716 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007717 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7718
7719 will generate:
7720
7721 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7722
7723 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007724
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02007725use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007726 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7728 no | yes | yes | no
7729 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007730 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
7731 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007732
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02007733 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
7734 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007735
7736 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7737 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7738 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007739 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7740 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7741 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7742 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007743
7744 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7745 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7746 assign the backend.
7747
7748 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7749 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7750 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7751 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7752 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7753 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7754
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007755 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007756 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007757 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7758 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7759 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7760
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007761 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
7762 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
7763 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
7764 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
7765 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
7766 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
7767 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
7768 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
7769 cannot be forced from the request.
7770
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007771 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007772 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
7773 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
7774
7775 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
7776 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007777
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007778
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007779use-server <server> if <condition>
7780use-server <server> unless <condition>
7781 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
7782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7783 no | no | yes | yes
7784 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007785 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007786
7787 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
7788
7789 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
7790 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7791 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7792
7793 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7794 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7795 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7796 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7797 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7798 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7799 matches will assign the server.
7800
7801 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7802 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7803 with the next rules until one matches.
7804
7805 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7806 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7807 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7808 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7809
7810 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7811 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7812 stripped.
7813
7814 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7815 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7816 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7817 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7818
7819 Example :
7820 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7821 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7822 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7823 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7824 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7825 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7826 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7827 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7828 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7829
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007830 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007831
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007832
78335. Bind and Server options
7834--------------------------
7835
7836The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7837depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7838settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7839written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7840described in this section.
7841
7842
78435.1. Bind options
7844-----------------
7845
7846The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7847as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7848no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7849parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7850while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7851provided immediately after the setting name.
7852
7853The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7854
7855accept-proxy
7856 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7857 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7858 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
7859 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
7860 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
7861 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
7862 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
7863 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
7864 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007865 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
7866 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007867
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007868alpn <protocols>
7869 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
7870 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
7871 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
7872 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
7873 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
7874 initial NPN extension.
7875
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007876backlog <backlog>
7877 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7878 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7879
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007880ecdhe <named curve>
7881 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01007882 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
7883 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007884
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007885ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007886 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7887 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7888 client's certificate.
7889
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007890ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7891 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7892 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7893 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7894 error is ignored.
7895
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007896ciphers <ciphers>
7897 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7898 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007899 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007900 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7901 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7902
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007903crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007904 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7905 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7906 to verify client's certificate.
7907
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007908crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007909 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7910 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
7911 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
7912 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
7913 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
7914 file.
7915
7916 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
7917 are loaded.
7918
7919 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
7920 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
7921 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
7922 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
7923 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
7924 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
7925 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
7926 www.sub.example.org).
7927
7928 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
7929 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
7930 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
7931 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
7932 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7933
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007934 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007935
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007936 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
7937 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08007938 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007939 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
7940 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
7941 clients).
7942
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007943crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007944 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
7945 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007946 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007947 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007948
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007949crt-list <file>
7950 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007951 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
7952 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007953
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007954 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007955
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007956 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
7957 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
7958 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
7959 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
7960 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
7961 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
7962 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
7963 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007964
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007965defer-accept
7966 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7967 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7968 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7969 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7970 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7971 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7972 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7973 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7974 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7975 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7976 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7977
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007978force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007979 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007980 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7981 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7982
7983force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007984 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007985 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7986
7987force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007988 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007989 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7990
7991force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007992 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007993 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7994
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007995gid <gid>
7996 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7997 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7998 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7999 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8000 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8001
8002group <group>
8003 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8004 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8005 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8006 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8007 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8008
8009id <id>
8010 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8011 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8012 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8013 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8014
8015interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008016 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8017 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8018 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8019 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8020 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8021 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8022 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008023
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008024level <level>
8025 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8026 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8027 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8028 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8029 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8030 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8031 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8032 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8033 counters).
8034 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8035 all counters).
8036
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008037maxconn <maxconn>
8038 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8039 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8040 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8041 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8042 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8043 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8044 eat all memory.
8045
8046mode <mode>
8047 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8048 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8049 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8050 UNIX sockets.
8051
8052mss <maxseg>
8053 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8054 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8055 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8056 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8057 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8058 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8059 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8060 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8061 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8062 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8063 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8064
8065name <name>
8066 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8067 page.
8068
8069nice <nice>
8070 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8071 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8072 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8073 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8074 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8075 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8076 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8077 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8078 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8079 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8080 one for an RDP socket.
8081
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008082no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008083 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008084 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008085 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008086 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8087 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008088
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008089no-tls-tickets
8090 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8091 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8092 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8093 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
8094
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008095no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008096 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008097 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008098 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8099 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8100 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008101
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008102no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008103 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008104 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008105 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8106 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8107 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008108
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008109no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008110 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008111 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008112 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8113 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8114 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008115
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008116npn <protocols>
8117 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8118 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8119 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8120 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008121 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8122 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008123
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008124ssl
8125 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008126 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008127 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8128 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8129 to deciphered contents.
8130
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008131strict-sni
8132 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8133 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8134 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8135 See the "crt" option for more information.
8136
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008137tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008138 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008139 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8140 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8141 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8142 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8143 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8144 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8145 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008146 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8147 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8148 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008149
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008150transparent
8151 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8152 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8153 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8154 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8155 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8156 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8157 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8158 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8159 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8160 so check for support with your vendor.
8161
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008162v4v6
8163 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8164 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8165 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8166 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008167 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008168
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008169v6only
8170 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8171 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8172 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008173 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8174 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008175
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008176uid <uid>
8177 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8178 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8179 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8180 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8181 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8182
8183user <user>
8184 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8185 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8186 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8187 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8188 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8189
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008190verify [none|optional|required]
8191 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8192 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8193 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8194 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8195 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008196 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8197 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8198 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8199 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008200
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020082015.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008202------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008203
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008204The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8205which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8206arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8207settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8208after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8209Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8210address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008212 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008213 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008214
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008215The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008216
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008217addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008218 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8219 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8220 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8221 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8222 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008223
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008224 Supported in default-server: No
8225
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008226agent-check
8227 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
8228 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP
8229 connection to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter" and reading
8230 an ASCII string. The string should have one of the following forms:
8231
8232 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
8233 e.g. "75%"
8234
8235 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8236 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8237
8238 * The string "drain".
8239
8240 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
8241 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
8242 persistence.
8243
8244 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
8245
8246 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
8247
8248 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
8249
8250 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8251
8252 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
8253
8254 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8255
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008256 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8257 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
8258 parameter.
8259
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008260 Requires the ""agent-port" parameter to be set.
8261 See also the "agent-check" parameter.
8262
8263 Supported in default-server: No
8264
8265agent-inter <delay>
8266 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8267 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8268
8269 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8270 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8271 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8272 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8273 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8274 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8275 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8276 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8277 of backends use the same servers.
8278
8279 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8280
8281 Supported in default-server: Yes
8282
8283agent-port <port>
8284 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8285
8286 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8287
8288 Supported in default-server: Yes
8289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008290backup
8291 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8292 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8293 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8294 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8295 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8296 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008297
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008298 Supported in default-server: No
8299
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008300ca-file <cafile>
8301 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8302 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8303 server's certificate.
8304
8305 Supported in default-server: No
8306
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008307check
8308 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008309 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8310 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8311 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8312 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8313 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8314 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8315 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008316 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8317 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8318 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008319
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008320 Supported in default-server: No
8321
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008322check-send-proxy
8323 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8324 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8325 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8326 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8327 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8328 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8329 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8330
8331 Supported in default-server: No
8332
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008333check-ssl
8334 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8335 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8336 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8337 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008338 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008339 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8340 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8341 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8342 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8343
8344 Supported in default-server: No
8345
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008346ciphers <ciphers>
8347 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008348 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008349 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8350 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8351 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8352 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8353 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8354 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8355
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008356 Supported in default-server: No
8357
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008358cookie <value>
8359 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8360 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8361 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8362 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8363 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8364 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8365 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8366
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008367 Supported in default-server: No
8368
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008369crl-file <crlfile>
8370 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8371 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8372 to verify server's certificate.
8373
8374 Supported in default-server: No
8375
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008376crt <cert>
8377 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8378 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8379 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8380 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8381 certificate request.
8382
8383 Supported in default-server: No
8384
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008385disabled
8386 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8387 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8388 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8389 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8390 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8391
8392 Supported in default-server: No
8393
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008394error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008395 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8396 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8397 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008398
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008399 Supported in default-server: Yes
8400
8401 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008402
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008403fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008404 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8405 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8406 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8407
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008408 Supported in default-server: Yes
8409
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008410force-sslv3
8411 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8412 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8413 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8414
8415 Supported in default-server: No
8416
8417force-tlsv10
8418 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8419 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8420
8421 Supported in default-server: No
8422
8423force-tlsv11
8424 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8425 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8426
8427 Supported in default-server: No
8428
8429force-tlsv12
8430 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8431 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8432
8433 Supported in default-server: No
8434
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008435id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008436 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8437 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8438 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008439
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008440 Supported in default-server: No
8441
8442inter <delay>
8443fastinter <delay>
8444downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008445 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8446 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8447 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8448 between checks depending on the server state :
8449
8450 Server state | Interval used
8451 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8452 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8453 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8454 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8455 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8456 or yet unchecked. |
8457 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8458 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8459 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008460
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008461 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8462 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8463 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8464 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008465 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8466 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8467 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8468 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8469 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008470
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008471 Supported in default-server: Yes
8472
8473maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008474 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8475 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8476 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8477 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8478 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8479 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8480 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8481 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8482
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008483 Supported in default-server: Yes
8484
8485maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008486 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8487 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8488 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8489 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8490 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8491 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8492 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8493
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008494 Supported in default-server: Yes
8495
8496minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008497 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8498 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8499 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8500 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8501 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8502 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008503 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008504 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008505
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008506 Supported in default-server: Yes
8507
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008508no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008509 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8510 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008511 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008512
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008513 Supported in default-server: No
8514
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008515no-tls-tickets
8516 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8517 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8518 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8519 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8520
8521 Supported in default-server: No
8522
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008523no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008524 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008525 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8526 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008527 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8528 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008529
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008530 Supported in default-server: No
8531
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008532no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008533 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008534 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8535 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008536 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8537 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008538
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008539 Supported in default-server: No
8540
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008541no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008542 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008543 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8544 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008545 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8546 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008547
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008548 Supported in default-server: No
8549
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008550non-stick
8551 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8552 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8553 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8554
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008555 Supported in default-server: No
8556
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008557observe <mode>
8558 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8559 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8560 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8561 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8562 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8563 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008564 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008565
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008566 Supported in default-server: No
8567
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008568 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8569
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008570on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008571 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8572 Currently, four modes are available:
8573 - fastinter: force fastinter
8574 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8575 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8576 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8577 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8578
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008579 Supported in default-server: Yes
8580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008581 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8582
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008583on-marked-down <action>
8584 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8585 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008586 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8587 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8588 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8589 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8590 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8591 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8592 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8593 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008594
8595 Actions are disabled by default
8596
8597 Supported in default-server: Yes
8598
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008599on-marked-up <action>
8600 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8601 Currently one action is available:
8602 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8603 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8604 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8605 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8606 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8607 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8608 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8609 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8610
8611 Actions are disabled by default
8612
8613 Supported in default-server: Yes
8614
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008615port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008616 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8617 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8618 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8619 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8620 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8621 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8622
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008623 Supported in default-server: Yes
8624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008625redir <prefix>
8626 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8627 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8628 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8629 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8630 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8631 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8632 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8633 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008634 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008635 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8636 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8637 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8638 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8639 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8640
8641 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8642
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008643 Supported in default-server: No
8644
8645rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008646 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8647 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8648 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8649
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008650 Supported in default-server: Yes
8651
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008652send-proxy
8653 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8654 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8655 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8656 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8657 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8658 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8659 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8660 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8661 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008662 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8663 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8664 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8665 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8666 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008667
8668 Supported in default-server: No
8669
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008670slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008671 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8672 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8673 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8674 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8675 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8676 parameters :
8677
8678 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8679 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8680
8681 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8682 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8683 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8684 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8685
8686 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8687 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8688 seen as failed.
8689
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008690 Supported in default-server: Yes
8691
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008692source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008693source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008694source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008695 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8696 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8697 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8698 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8699
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008700 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8701 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8702 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8703 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8704 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8705 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8706 server.
8707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008708 Supported in default-server: No
8709
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008710ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008711 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
8712 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
8713 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
8714 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
8715 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
8716 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008717 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008718
8719 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008720
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008721track [<proxy>/]<server>
8722 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
8723 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
8724 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
8725 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
8726 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
8727
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008728 Supported in default-server: No
8729
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008730verify [none|required]
8731 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01008732 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
8733 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
8734 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
8735 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008736 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
8737 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
8738 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008739
8740 Supported in default-server: No
8741
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07008742verifyhost <hostname>
8743 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
8744 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
8745 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
8746 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
8747 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
8748 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
8749
8750 Supported in default-server: No
8751
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008752weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008753 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
8754 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
8755 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02008756 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
8757 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
8758 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
8759 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
8760 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
8761 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008762
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008763 Supported in default-server: Yes
8764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008765
87666. HTTP header manipulation
8767---------------------------
8768
8769In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
8770response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
8771request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
8772which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008773against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008774
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008775If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
8776to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
8777but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
8778HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
8779stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
8780because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
8781a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
8782still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008783
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008784This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
8785in section 4.2 :
8786
8787 - reqadd <string>
8788 - reqallow <search>
8789 - reqiallow <search>
8790 - reqdel <search>
8791 - reqidel <search>
8792 - reqdeny <search>
8793 - reqideny <search>
8794 - reqpass <search>
8795 - reqipass <search>
8796 - reqrep <search> <replace>
8797 - reqirep <search> <replace>
8798 - reqtarpit <search>
8799 - reqitarpit <search>
8800 - rspadd <string>
8801 - rspdel <search>
8802 - rspidel <search>
8803 - rspdeny <search>
8804 - rspideny <search>
8805 - rsprep <search> <replace>
8806 - rspirep <search> <replace>
8807
8808With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
8809is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
8810parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
8811prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
8812Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
8813
8814 \t for a tab
8815 \r for a carriage return (CR)
8816 \n for a new line (LF)
8817 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
8818 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
8819 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
8820 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
8821 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
8822
8823The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
8824portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
8825above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
8826regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
88279 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
8828is very common to users of the "sed" program.
8829
8830The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
8831after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
8832
8833Notes related to these keywords :
8834---------------------------------
8835 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
8836 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
8837 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
8838
8839 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
8840 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
8841 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
8842
8843 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
8844 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
8845 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
8846 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
8847 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
8848
8849 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
8850 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
8851 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
8852 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
8853 useless headers before adding new ones.
8854
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008855 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008856 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
8857
8858 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
8859 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
8860 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
8861
8862 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
8863 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008864 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008865
8866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020088677. Using ACLs and fetching samples
8868----------------------------------
8869
8870Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
8871client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
8872The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
8873these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
8874but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
8875data called patterns.
8876
8877
88787.1. ACL basics
8879---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008880
8881The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
8882content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
8883from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
8884simple :
8885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008886 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008887 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008888 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
8889 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008891The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
8892adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008893
8894In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
8895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008896 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008897
8898This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
8899Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
8900and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008901an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
8902conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
8903as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
8904are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008905
8906ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
8907'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
8908which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
8909
8910There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
8911performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
8912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008913The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
8914specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
8915this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008916methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
8917ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008918
8919Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
8920 - boolean
8921 - integer (signed or unsigned)
8922 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
8923 - string
8924 - data block
8925
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008926Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
8927converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
8928would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
8929The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
8930which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
8931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008932The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
8933 - boolean
8934 - integer or integer range
8935 - IP address / network
8936 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
8937 - regular expression
8938 - hex block
8939
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008940The following ACL flags are currently supported :
8941
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008942 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
8943 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008944 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01008945 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01008946 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01008947 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008948 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
8949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008950The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
8951read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
8952if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
8953lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
8954will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
8955beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
8956a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
8957lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
8958exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
8959
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01008960The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
8961parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
8962ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
8963a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
8964check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
8965
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01008966The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
8967socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
8968file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
8969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008970Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
8971loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
8972
8973 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
8974
8975In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
8976the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
8977case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
8978as well.
8979
8980The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
8981sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
8982do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
8983methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
8984is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
8985obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
8986followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
8987default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
8988that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
8989string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
8990
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01008991The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
8992By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
8993string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
8994resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
8995server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
8996waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
8997flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
8998function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
8999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009000There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9001sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9002be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009003
9004 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9005 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009006 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9007 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9008 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9009 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009010
9011 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9012 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009013 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009014
9015 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009016 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009017
9018 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009019 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009020
9021 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9022 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9023
9024 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9025 binary or string samples.
9026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009027 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9028 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009030 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9031 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9032 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009034 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9035 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009037 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9038 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009040 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9041 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009043 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9044 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009045 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009047 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9048 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9049 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009050
9051For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9052request, it is possible to do :
9053
9054 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9055
9056In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9057buffer, one would use the following acl :
9058
9059 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9060
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009061On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9062possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9063
9064 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009066All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9067criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9068method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9069to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9070criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9071the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009073If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009074the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9075For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009077 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9078 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9079 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9080 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009081
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009082
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009083The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample types
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009084and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9085combination the name of the matching method to be used, prefixed with "*" when
9086the method is implicit and will work by default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009088 +-------------------------------------------------+
9089 | Input sample type |
9090 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9091 | pattern type | boolean | integer | IP | string | binary |
9092 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9093 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9094 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009095 | none (boolean value) | *bool | bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009096 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009097 | integer (value) | int | *int | int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009098 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009099 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009100 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009101 | IP address | | | *ip | ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009102 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009103 | exact string | str | str | str | str | str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009104 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009105 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009106 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009107 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009108 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009109 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009110 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009111 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009112 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009113 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009114 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009115 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009116 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9117 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9118 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009119
9120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091217.1.1. Matching booleans
9122------------------------
9123
9124In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9125Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9126When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9127that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9128
9129Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9130return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9131"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9132
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091347.1.2. Matching integers
9135------------------------
9136
9137Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9138enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9139to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9140
9141Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9142matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9143lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009144
9145For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9146unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9147representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9148
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009149As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9150two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9151instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9152ranges and operators.
9153
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009154For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009155operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9156Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9157of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009158
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009159Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009160
9161 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9162 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9163 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9164 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9165 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9166
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009167For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009168
9169 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9170
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009171This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9172
9173 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9174
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091767.1.3. Matching strings
9177-----------------------
9178
9179String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9180different forms :
9181
9182 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9183 patterns ;
9184
9185 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9186 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9187
9188 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9189 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9190
9191 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9192 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9193
9194 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9195 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9196 matches.
9197
9198 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9199 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9200 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009201
9202String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9203exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9204characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9205string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9206to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009207before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009208
9209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020092107.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9211---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009212
9213Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9214they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9215possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9216passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9217the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009218the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9219match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009220
9221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020092227.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9223-------------------------------------
9224
9225It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9226not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9227a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9228to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9229digits may be used upper or lower case.
9230
9231Example :
9232 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9233 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9234
9235
92367.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9237---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009238
9239IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9240netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9241within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009242host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009243difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9244at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9245does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9246parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009247
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009248IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9249Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9250trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9251IPv6 patterns.
9252
9253HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9254following situations :
9255 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9256 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9257 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9258 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9259 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9260 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9261 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9262 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9263 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9264 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009266
92677.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9268----------------------------------
9269
9270Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9271combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9272
9273 - AND (implicit)
9274 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9275 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009277A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009279 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009281Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9282indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009284For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9285"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9286requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9287is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9288
9289 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9290 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9291 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9292 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9293
9294To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9295and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9296
9297 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9298 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9299 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9300 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9301
9302 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9303 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9304 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9305 use_backend www if host_www
9306
9307It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9308expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9309be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9310the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9311
9312 The following rule :
9313
9314 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9315 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9316
9317 Can also be written that way :
9318
9319 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9320
9321It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9322to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9323simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9324sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9325good use is the following :
9326
9327 With named ACLs :
9328
9329 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9330 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9331 monitor fail if site_dead
9332
9333 With anonymous ACLs :
9334
9335 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9336
9337See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9338
9339
93407.3. Fetching samples
9341---------------------
9342
9343Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9344against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9345sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9346ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9347of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9348available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9349
9350This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9351Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9352compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9353deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9354
9355The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9356matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9357method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9358indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9359
9360As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9361when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9362mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9363the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9364ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9365
9366Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9367multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9368when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9369incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9370are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9371is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9372all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9373
9374Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9375 - name
9376 - name(arg1)
9377 - name(arg1,arg2)
9378
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009379
93807.3.1. Converters
9381-----------------
9382
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009383Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9384of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9385is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9386was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9387has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9388unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9389
9390These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9391sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9392the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9393support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009395The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009396
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009397lower
9398 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
9399 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9400 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009401
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009402upper
9403 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
9404 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9405 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009406
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009407hex
9408 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9409 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9410 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9411 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009412
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009413ipmask(<mask>)
9414 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
9415 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
9416 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
9417 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009418
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009419http_date([<offset>])
9420 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9421 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9422 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9423 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
9424 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
9425 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009426
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009427language(<value>[,<default>])
9428 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
9429 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
9430 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
9431 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
9432 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
9433 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
9434 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
9435 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
9436 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
9437 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
9438 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
9439 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009440
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009441 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009442
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009443 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
9444 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009445
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009446 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
9447 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
9448 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
9449 use_backend spanish if es
9450 use_backend french if fr
9451 use_backend english if en
9452 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009453
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009454map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9455map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9456map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9457 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
9458 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
9459 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
9460 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
9461 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
9462 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
9463 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
9464 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009465
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009466 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
9467 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
9468 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009469
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009470 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
9471 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009472
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009473 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
9474 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9475 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
9476 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9477 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
9478 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9479 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
9480 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9481 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
9482 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9483 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
9484 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9485 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
9486 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9487 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
9488 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9489 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
9490 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009491
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009492 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
9493 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
9494 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
9495 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9496 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009497
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009498 Example :
9499
9500 # this is a comment and is ignored
9501 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9502 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
9503 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
9504 | | | `---------- value
9505 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
9506 | `---------------------------- key
9507 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
9508
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009509
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020095107.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009511--------------------------------------------
9512
9513A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
9514not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
9515"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
9516The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
9517
9518always_false : boolean
9519 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9520 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9521
9522always_true : boolean
9523 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9524 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9525
9526avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009527 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009528 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
9529 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
9530 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
9531 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
9532 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
9533 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
9534 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
9535 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
9536 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
9537 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
9538 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
9539 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
9540 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01009541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009542be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009543 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
9544 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
9545 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
9546 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
9547 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009549be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
9550 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9551 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9552 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
9553 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
9554 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
9555 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009556
9557 Example :
9558 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
9559 backend dynamic
9560 mode http
9561 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
9562 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009564connslots([<backend>]) : integer
9565 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009566 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009567 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
9568 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05009569
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009570 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009571 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009572 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
9573
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009574 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
9575 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009576
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009577 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009578 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009579 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009580 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
9581 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009582 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009583 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009584
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009585 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
9586 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009587 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009588 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009589
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009590date([<offset>]) : integer
9591 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
9592 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
9593 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
9594 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009595 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
9596
9597 Example :
9598
9599 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
9600 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009601
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02009602env(<name>) : string
9603 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
9604 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
9605 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
9606 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
9607 certain way.
9608
9609 Examples :
9610 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
9611 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
9612
9613 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
9614 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
9615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009616fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
9617 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009618 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
9619 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009620 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
9621 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
9622 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
9623 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
9624 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009626fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
9627 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9628 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9629 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
9630 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
9631 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
9632 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
9633 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
9634 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009635
9636 Example :
9637 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
9638 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
9639 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
9640 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
9641 frontend mail
9642 bind :25
9643 mode tcp
9644 maxconn 100
9645 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
9646 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
9647 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
9648 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009650nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
9651 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
9652 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
9653 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009654 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
9655 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
9656 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009658queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009659 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
9660 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
9661 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009662 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
9663 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
9664 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
9665 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
9666 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
9667
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +01009668rand([<range>]) : integer
9669 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
9670 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
9671 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
9672 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
9673 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
9674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009675srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9676 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9677 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
9678 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
9679 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
9680 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
9681 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
9682 methods.
9683
9684srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
9685 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
9686 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
9687 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
9688 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
9689 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
9690 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
9691 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
9692
9693srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9694 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9695 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009696 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009697 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
9698 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
9699 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
9700 overloading servers).
9701
9702 Example :
9703 # Redirect to a separate back
9704 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
9705 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
9706 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
9707
9708table_avl([<table>]) : integer
9709 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
9710 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
9711
9712table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9713 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
9714 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
9715 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
9716
9717
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020097187.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009719----------------------------------
9720
9721The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
9722closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
9723methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
9724sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
9725TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009726the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
9727counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
9728"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009729argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
9730the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
9731this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009732
9733be_id : integer
9734 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
9735 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
9736
9737dst : ip
9738 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
9739 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
9740 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9741 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
9742 RFC 4291.
9743
9744dst_conn : integer
9745 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9746 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
9747 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
9748 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
9749 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
9750 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
9751 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
9752 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009754dst_port : integer
9755 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
9756 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
9757 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
9758 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
9759 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
9760 an HTTP header.
9761
9762fe_id : integer
9763 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
9764 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
9765 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
9766
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009767sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009768sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9769sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9770sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009771 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
9772 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9773 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
9774
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009775sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009776sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9777sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9778sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009779 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
9780 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9781 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
9782
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009783sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009784sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9785sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9786sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009787 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
9788 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009789 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
9790 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
9791 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009792
9793 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9794 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009795 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9796 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
9797 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009798 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9799 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9800
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009801sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009802sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9803sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9804sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009805 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
9806 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
9807
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009808sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009809sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9810sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9811sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009812 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9813 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
9814 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
9815
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009816sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009817sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9818sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9819sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009820 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
9821 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
9822 See also src_conn_rate.
9823
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009824sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009825sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9826sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9827sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009828 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009829 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009830
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009831sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009832sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9833sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9834sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009835 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9836 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
9837 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009838 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9839 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9840 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009841
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009842sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009843sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9844sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9845sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009846 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
9847 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
9848 See also src_http_err_cnt.
9849
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009850sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009851sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9852sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9853sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009854 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
9855 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9856 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
9857 src_http_err_rate.
9858
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009859sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009860sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9861sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9862sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009863 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9864 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9865 src_http_req_cnt.
9866
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009867sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009868sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9869sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9870sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009871 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9872 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
9873 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9874 src_http_req_rate.
9875
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009876sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009877sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9878sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9879sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009880 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009881 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
9882 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
9883 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
9884 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009885
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009886 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9887 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009888 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9889
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009890sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009891sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9892sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9893sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009894 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
9895 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9896 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9897 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
9898
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009899sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009900sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9901sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9902sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009903 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
9904 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9905 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9906 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
9907
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009908sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009909sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9910sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9911sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009912 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
9913 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
9914 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
9915 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009916 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009917 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
9918
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009919sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009920sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9921sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9922sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009923 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
9924 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9925 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
9926 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
9927 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009928 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009929
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009930sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009931sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9932sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9933sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +02009934 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
9935 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
9936 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
9937
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009938sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009939sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9940sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9941sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009942 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9943 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009944 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009945 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
9946 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009947 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
9948 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
9949 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009951so_id : integer
9952 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
9953 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
9954 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009956src : ip
9957 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
9958 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
9959 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
9960 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
9961 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
9962 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
9963 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009964
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009965 Example:
9966 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
9967 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
9968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009969src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9970 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
9971 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
9972 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009973 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009975src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9976 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
9977 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009978 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009979 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009981src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9982 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9983 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9984 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
9985 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
9986 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
9987 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009988
9989 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9990 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
9991 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
9992 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009993 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009994 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9995 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009997src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009998 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009999 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010000 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010001 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010003src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010004 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010005 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10006 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010007 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010009src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10010 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10011 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10012 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010013 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010015src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010016 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010017 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010018 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010019 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010021src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010022 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010023 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010024 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10025 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010026 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10027 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10028 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010030src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10031 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10032 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010033 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010034 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010035 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010037src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10038 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10039 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10040 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10041 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010042 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010044src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10045 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10046 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10047 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010048 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010050src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10051 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10052 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10053 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010054 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010055 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010057src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10058 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10059 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10060 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010061 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010062 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10063 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010064
10065 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010066 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010067 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010069src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10070 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
10071 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10072 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
10073 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010074 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
10075 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010077src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10078 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
10079 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010080 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
10081 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010082 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010084src_port : integer
10085 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10086 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10087 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10088 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010090src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10091 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010092 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10093 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10094 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010095 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010097src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10098 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10099 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10100 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10101 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010102 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010104src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10105 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10106 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10107 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10108 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10109 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10110 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10111 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10112 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010113
10114 Example :
10115 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10116 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10117 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10118 listen ssh
10119 bind :22
10120 mode tcp
10121 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010122 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010123 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010124 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010126srv_id : integer
10127 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10128 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10129 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010130
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010131
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200101327.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010133----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010135The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10136closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10137when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10138usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010139future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010141ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10142 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10143 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10144 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10145 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10146 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010148ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10149 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10150 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10151 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10152 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010154ssl_c_err : integer
10155 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10156 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10157 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10158 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10159 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010161ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10162 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10163 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10164 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10165 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10166 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10167 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10168 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10169 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010171 ACL derivatives :
10172 ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010174ssl_c_key_alg : string
10175 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10176 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10177 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010179 ACL derivatives :
10180 ssl_c_key_alg : exact string match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020010181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010182ssl_c_notafter : string
10183 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10184 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10185 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010187 ACL derivatives :
10188 ssl_c_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010190ssl_c_notbefore : string
10191 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10192 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10193 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010195 ACL derivatives :
10196 ssl_c_notbefore : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010198ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10199 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10200 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10201 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10202 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10203 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10204 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10205 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10206 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010208 ACL derivatives :
10209 ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010211ssl_c_serial : binary
10212 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10213 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10214 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010216 ACL derivatives :
10217 ssl_c_serial : hex block match
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010219ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10220 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10221 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10222 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010224ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10225 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10226 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10227 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010229 ACL derivatives :
10230 ssl_c_sig_alg : exact string match
10231
10232ssl_c_used : boolean
10233 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10234 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010236ssl_c_verify : integer
10237 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10238 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10239 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10240 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010242ssl_c_version : integer
10243 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10244 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010246ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10247 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10248 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10249 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10250 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010251 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010252 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10253 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10254 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010256 ACL derivatives :
10257 ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +020010258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010259ssl_f_key_alg : string
10260 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10261 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10262 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010264 ACL derivatives :
10265 ssl_f_key_alg : exact string match
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010267ssl_f_notafter : string
10268 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10269 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10270 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010272 ACL derivatives :
10273 ssl_f_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +020010274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010275ssl_f_notbefore : string
10276 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10277 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10278 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010280 ACL derivatives :
10281 ssl_f_notbefore : exact string match
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010283ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10284 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10285 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10286 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10287 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10288 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10289 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10290 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10291 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010293 ACL derivatives :
10294 ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010296ssl_f_serial : binary
10297 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10298 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10299 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010301 ACL derivatives :
10302 ssl_f_serial : hex block match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +020010303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010304ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10305 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10306 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10307 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010309 ACL derivatives :
10310 ssl_f_sig_alg : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +020010311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010312ssl_f_version : integer
10313 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10314 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10315
10316ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010317 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10318 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10319 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010321 Example :
10322 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10323 listen http-https
10324 bind :80
10325 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10326 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10327
10328ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10329 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10330 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10331
10332ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010333 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010334 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10335 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10336 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10337 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10338 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10339 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10340 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10341 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10342
10343 ACL derivatives :
10344 ssl_fc_alpn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010346ssl_fc_cipher : string
10347 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10348 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010350 ACL derivatives :
10351 ssl_fc_cipher : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010353ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010354 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10355 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010356 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10357 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10358 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10359 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010361ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10362 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010363 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10364 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10365 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10366 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010368ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010369 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010370 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10371 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10372 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10373 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10374 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10375 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10376 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010378 ACL derivatives :
10379 ssl_fc_npn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010381ssl_fc_protocol : string
10382 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10383 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010385 ACL derivatives :
10386 ssl_fc_protocol : exact string match
10387
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010388ssl_fc_unique_id : string
10389 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10390 returns a base64 encoded string containing the TLS unique ID as defined
10391 in RFC5929 section 3.
10392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010393ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10394 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10395 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10396 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10397 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010399ssl_fc_sni : string
10400 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10401 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10402 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10403 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10404 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10405
10406 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10407 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10408 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010409 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10410 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010412 ACL derivatives :
10413 ssl_fc_sni : exact string match
10414 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10415 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010417ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10418 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10419 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010420
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010421
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200104227.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010423------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010425Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10426sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10427only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10428For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10429be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10430can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10431sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10432for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10433content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010435payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10436 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10437 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10438 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010440payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10441 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10442 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10443 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010445req.len : integer
10446req_len : integer (deprecated)
10447 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10448 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10449 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10450 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10451 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10452 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10453 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10454 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010456req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10457 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010458 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10459 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10460 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10461 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010463 ACL alternatives :
10464 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010466req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10467 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10468 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10469 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10470 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010472 ACL alternatives :
10473 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010475 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010477req.proto_http : boolean
10478req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10479 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10480 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10481 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10482 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10483 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10484 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10485 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010487 Example:
10488 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10489 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10490 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010491 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010493req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10494rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10495 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10496 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10497 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10498 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10499 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10500 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10501 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010503 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10504 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10505 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
10506 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
10507 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
10508 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010510 ACL derivatives :
10511 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010513 Example :
10514 listen tse-farm
10515 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
10516 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10517 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10518 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10519 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10520 persist rdp-cookie
10521 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
10522 # This is only useful makes sense if
10523 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
10524 stick-table type string size 204800
10525 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
10526 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10527 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010529 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
10530 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010532req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
10533rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
10534 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
10535 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
10536 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
10537 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010539 ACL derivatives :
10540 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010542req.ssl_hello_type : integer
10543req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10544 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10545 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
10546 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10547 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10548 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
10549 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10550 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010552req.ssl_sni : string
10553req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
10554 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
10555 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
10556 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
10557 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10558 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10559 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
10560 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
10561 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
10562 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
10563 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
10564 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
10565 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010567 ACL derivatives :
10568 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010570 Examples :
10571 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
10572 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10573 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
10574 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
10575 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010577res.ssl_hello_type : integer
10578rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10579 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10580 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
10581 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10582 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10583 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
10584 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10585 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020010586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010587req.ssl_ver : integer
10588req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
10589 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
10590 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
10591 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
10592 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
10593 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10594 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10595 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
10596 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
10597 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010599 ACL derivatives :
10600 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010601
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020010602res.len : integer
10603 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10604 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10605 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10606 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10607 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10608 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10609 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
10610 content inspection.
10611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010612res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10613 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010614 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10615 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10616 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10617 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010619res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10620 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10621 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10622 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
10623 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010625 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010627wait_end : boolean
10628 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
10629 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
10630 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
10631 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
10632 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
10633 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
10634 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
10635 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010637 Examples :
10638 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
10639 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
10640 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010642 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
10643 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10644 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
10645 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
10646 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
10647 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
10648 tcp-request content reject
10649
10650
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200106517.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010652--------------------------------------
10653
10654It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
10655This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
10656data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
10657its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
10658HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
10659content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
10660to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
10661more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
10662response are indexed.
10663
10664base : string
10665 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
10666 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
10667 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
10668 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
10669 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
10670 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
10671 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
10672 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
10673
10674 ACL derivatives :
10675 base : exact string match
10676 base_beg : prefix match
10677 base_dir : subdir match
10678 base_dom : domain match
10679 base_end : suffix match
10680 base_len : length match
10681 base_reg : regex match
10682 base_sub : substring match
10683
10684base32 : integer
10685 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
10686 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
10687 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
10688 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
10689
10690base32+src : binary
10691 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
10692 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
10693 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
10694 per-URL counters.
10695
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010010696capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
10697 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
10698 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10699 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
10700
10701capture.req.method : string
10702 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
10703 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
10704 because it's allocated.
10705
10706capture.req.uri : string
10707 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
10708 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
10709 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
10710 allocated.
10711
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020010712capture.req.ver : string
10713 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
10714 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
10715 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
10716
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010010717capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
10718 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
10719 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10720 The first entry is an index of 0.
10721 See also: "capture response header"
10722
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020010723capture.res.ver : string
10724 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
10725 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
10726 persistent flag.
10727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010728req.cook([<name>]) : string
10729cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10730 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10731 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10732 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
10733 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
10734 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
10735 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
10736 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
10737 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
10738
10739 ACL derivatives :
10740 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
10741 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
10742 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
10743 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
10744 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
10745 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
10746 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
10747 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010749req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10750cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10751 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10752 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010754req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10755cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10756 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10757 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
10758 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
10759 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010761cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10762 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10763 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
10764 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
10765 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
10766 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
10767 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
10768 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
10769 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
10770 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
10771 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010773hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10774 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
10775 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
10776 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
10777 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010778 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010780req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
10781 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10782 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10783 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10784 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10785 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10786 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
10787 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
10788 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010790req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10791 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10792 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10793 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10794 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010796req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10797 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10798 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10799 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10800 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10801 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10802 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
10803 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
10804 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
10805 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
10806 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
10807 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010809 ACL derivatives :
10810 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10811 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10812 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10813 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10814 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10815 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10816 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10817 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10818
10819req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10820hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
10821 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10822 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
10823 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
10824 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
10825 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
10826 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
10827 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
10828 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
10829 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
10830
10831req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10832hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10833 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
10834 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
10835 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
10836 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10837 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10838 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10839 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
10840 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
10841
10842req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10843hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10844 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
10845 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
10846 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
10847 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10848 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10849 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10850 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
10851
10852http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
10853 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10854 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
10855 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10856 basic auth is supported.
10857
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010010858http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
10859 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
10860 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
10861 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
10862 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010863 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10864 basic auth is supported.
10865
10866 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010010867 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
10868 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
10869 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
10870 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010871
10872http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010873 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
10874 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010875 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
10876 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010878method : integer + string
10879 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
10880 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
10881 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
10882 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
10883 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
10884 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
10885 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010887 ACL derivatives :
10888 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010890 Example :
10891 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
10892 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
10893 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010895path : string
10896 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
10897 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
10898 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
10899 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
10900 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
10901 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
10902 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010904 ACL derivatives :
10905 path : exact string match
10906 path_beg : prefix match
10907 path_dir : subdir match
10908 path_dom : domain match
10909 path_end : suffix match
10910 path_len : length match
10911 path_reg : regex match
10912 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010914req.ver : string
10915req_ver : string (deprecated)
10916 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
10917 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
10918 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010920 ACL derivatives :
10921 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010923res.comp : boolean
10924 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
10925 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
10926 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010928res.comp_algo : string
10929 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
10930 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
10931 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010933res.cook([<name>]) : string
10934scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10935 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10936 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10937 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010939 ACL derivatives :
10940 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010942res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10943scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10944 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10945 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
10946 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010948res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10949scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10950 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10951 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
10952 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010954res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10955 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10956 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10957 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10958 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10959 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
10960 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
10961 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
10962 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
10963 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010965res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10966 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10967 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10968 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10969 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
10970 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010972res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10973shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
10974 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10975 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10976 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10977 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10978 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
10979 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
10980 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
10981 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010983 ACL derivatives :
10984 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10985 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10986 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10987 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10988 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10989 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10990 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10991 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10992
10993res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10994shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10995 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10996 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10997 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
10998 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
10999 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011001res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11002shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11003 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11004 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11005 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11006 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11007 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11008 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011010res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11011shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11012 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11013 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11014 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11015 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11016 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11017 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011019res.ver : string
11020resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11021 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11022 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011024 ACL derivatives :
11025 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011027set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11028 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11029 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11030 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11031 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011033 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11034 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011036 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011038status : integer
11039 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11040 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11041 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011043url : string
11044 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11045 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11046 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11047 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11048 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11049 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11050 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011052 ACL derivatives :
11053 url : exact string match
11054 url_beg : prefix match
11055 url_dir : subdir match
11056 url_dom : domain match
11057 url_end : suffix match
11058 url_len : length match
11059 url_reg : regex match
11060 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011062url_ip : ip
11063 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11064 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11065 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11066 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11067 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11068 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11069 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011071url_port : integer
11072 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11073 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11074 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11075 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011077urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11078url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11079 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11080 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11081 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11082 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11083 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11084 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11085 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11086 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11087 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011089 ACL derivatives :
11090 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11091 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11092 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11093 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11094 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11095 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11096 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11097 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011098
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011100 Example :
11101 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11102 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11103 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11104 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011106urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11107 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11108 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11109 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011110
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200111127.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011113---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011115Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11116every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011117order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011118
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011119ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11120---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011121FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011122HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011123HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11124HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011125HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11126HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11127HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11128HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11129LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011130METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11131METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11132METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11133METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11134METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11135METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011136RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011137REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011138TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011139WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11140---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011141
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011142
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111438. Logging
11144----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011145
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011146One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11147provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11148very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11149provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11150state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011151to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011152headers.
11153
11154In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11155about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11156send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11157
11158 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11159 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11160 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11161 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11162 at the termination.
11163
11164The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11165allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11166as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11167while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11168real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11169delay.
11170
11171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111728.1. Log levels
11173---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011174
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011175TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011176source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011177HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11178in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11179track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11180syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11181about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011182
11183
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111848.2. Log formats
11185----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011186
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011187HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011188and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11189slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11190options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011191
11192 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11193 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11194 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11195 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11196 extents.
11197
11198 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11199 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11200 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11201 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11202 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11203
11204 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11205 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11206 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11207 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11208 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11209
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011210 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11211 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11212 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11213 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11214
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011215 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11216
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011217Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11218specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11219field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11220servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11221always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11222identifier.
11223
11224Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11225 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11226 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11227 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11228 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11229
11230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112318.2.1. Default log format
11232-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011233
11234This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11235as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11236format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11237
11238 Example :
11239 listen www
11240 mode http
11241 log global
11242 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11243
11244 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11245 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11246 (www/HTTP)
11247
11248 Field Format Extract from the example above
11249 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11250 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11251 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11252 4 'to' to
11253 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11254 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11255
11256Detailed fields description :
11257 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11258 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11259 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11260 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11261 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11262 and processed the connection.
11263 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11264
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011265In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11266"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11267connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11268
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011269It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11270will eventually disappear.
11271
11272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112738.2.2. TCP log format
11274---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011275
11276The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11277is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11278information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11279counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11280emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11281environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11282the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11283sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011284specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11285not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11286fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11287marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011288
11289 Example :
11290 frontend fnt
11291 mode tcp
11292 option tcplog
11293 log global
11294 default_backend bck
11295
11296 backend bck
11297 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11298
11299 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11300 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11301 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11302
11303 Field Format Extract from the example above
11304 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11305 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11306 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11307 4 frontend_name fnt
11308 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11309 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11310 7 bytes_read* 212
11311 8 termination_state --
11312 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11313 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11314
11315Detailed fields description :
11316 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011317 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11318 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11319 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11320 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11321 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011322
11323 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011324 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11325 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11326 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011327
11328 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11329 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11330 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11331 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11332
11333 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11334 and processed the connection.
11335
11336 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11337 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11338 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11339 applications.
11340
11341 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11342 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11343 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11344 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11345 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11346
11347 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11348 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11349 See "Timers" below for more details.
11350
11351 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11352 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11353 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11354 "Timers" below for more details.
11355
11356 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011357 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011358 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11359 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11360 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11361 details.
11362
11363 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11364 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11365 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11366 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11367 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11368
11369 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11370 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11371 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11372 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11373 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11374 for more details.
11375
11376 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011377 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011378 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11379 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11380 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011381 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011382
11383 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11384 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11385 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11386 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11387 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11388 caused by a denial of service attack.
11389
11390 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11391 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11392 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11393 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11394 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11395 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11396 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11397 denial of service attack.
11398
11399 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11400 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11401 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11402 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11403 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11404 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11405 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11406 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11407 be processed than on other servers.
11408
11409 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11410 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11411 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11412 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11413 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11414 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11415 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11416 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11417 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11418 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11419 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11420 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11421 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11422
11423 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11424 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11425 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11426 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11427 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11428 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11429 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11430 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11431
11432 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11433 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11434 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11435 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11436 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11437 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11438 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11439 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11440 occurs.
11441
11442
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114438.2.3. HTTP log format
11444----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011445
11446The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11447is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11448the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11449are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11450emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11451generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11452"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11453which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011454frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11455is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011456
11457Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11458slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11459with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11460
11461 Example :
11462 frontend http-in
11463 mode http
11464 option httplog
11465 log global
11466 default_backend bck
11467
11468 backend static
11469 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11470
11471 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11472 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11473 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011474 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011475
11476 Field Format Extract from the example above
11477 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11478 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11479 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11480 4 frontend_name http-in
11481 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11482 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11483 7 status_code 200
11484 8 bytes_read* 2750
11485 9 captured_request_cookie -
11486 10 captured_response_cookie -
11487 11 termination_state ----
11488 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11489 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11490 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11491 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11492 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011493
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011494
11495Detailed fields description :
11496 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011497 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11498 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11499 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11500 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11501 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011502
11503 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011504 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11505 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11506 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011507
11508 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
11509 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
11510 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
11511 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
11512 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
11513
11514 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11515 and processed the connection.
11516
11517 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11518 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11519 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
11520
11521 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11522 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11523 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11524 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
11525 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
11526 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
11527
11528 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
11529 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
11530 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
11531 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
11532 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
11533 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
11534
11535 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11536 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11537 See "Timers" below for more details.
11538
11539 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11540 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11541 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
11542 below for more details.
11543
11544 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
11545 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
11546 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
11547 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
11548 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
11549 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
11550 for more details.
11551
11552 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011553 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011554 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11555 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11556 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11557 details.
11558
11559 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
11560 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
11561 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
11562
11563 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
11564 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
11565 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
11566 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
11567 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
11568 overflowing.
11569
11570 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
11571 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
11572 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
11573 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
11574 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
11575 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
11576 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
11577 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11578
11579 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
11580 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
11581 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
11582 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
11583 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
11584 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
11585 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
11586 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11587
11588 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11589 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11590 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
11591 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
11592 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
11593 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
11594 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
11595
11596 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011597 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011598 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
11599 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
11600 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011601 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011602 system.
11603
11604 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11605 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11606 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11607 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11608 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11609 caused by a denial of service attack.
11610
11611 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11612 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11613 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11614 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11615 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11616 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11617 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11618 denial of service attack.
11619
11620 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11621 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11622 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11623 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11624 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11625 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11626 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11627 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
11628 processed than on other servers.
11629
11630 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11631 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11632 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11633 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11634 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11635 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11636 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11637 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11638 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11639 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11640 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11641 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11642 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11643
11644 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11645 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11646 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11647 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11648 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11649 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11650 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11651 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11652
11653 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11654 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11655 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11656 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11657 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11658 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11659 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11660 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11661 occurs.
11662
11663 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
11664 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
11665 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
11666 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
11667 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
11668 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
11669 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
11670 cookies" below for more details.
11671
11672 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
11673 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
11674 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
11675 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
11676 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
11677 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
11678 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
11679 and cookies" below for more details.
11680
11681 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
11682 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
11683 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
11684 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
11685 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
11686 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
11687 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
11688 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
11689
11690
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200116918.2.4. Custom log format
11692------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011693
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011694The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011695mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011696
11697HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
11698Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
11699separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
11700prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
11701
11702Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
11703variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
11704string formats ("Q").
11705
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011706If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011707as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011708less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
11709the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
11710
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011711Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011712In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010011713in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011714
11715Flags are :
11716 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011717 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011718
11719 Example:
11720
11721 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
11722 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
11723
11724At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
11725
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011726 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
11727 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011728
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011729the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011730
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011731 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011732 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011733 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011734
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011735and the default TCP format is defined this way :
11736
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011737 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011738 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
11739
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011740Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
11741
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011742 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011743 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011744 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
11745 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
11746 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011747 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
11748 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
11749 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011750 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011751 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011752 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011753 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011754 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080011755 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011756 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
11757 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011758 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011759 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
11760 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011761 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011762 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
11763 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011764 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11765 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
11766 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011767 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011768 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
11769 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011770 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011771 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11772 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
11773 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011774 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011775 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
11776 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
11777 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
11778 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011779 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011780 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011781 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011782 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010011783 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011784 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011785 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
11786 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
11787 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011788 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011789 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
11790 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011791 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011792 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011793 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011794 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011795
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011796 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011797
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010011798
117998.2.5. Error log format
11800-----------------------
11801
11802When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
11803protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
11804By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
11805"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
11806will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
11807logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
11808
11809The format looks like this :
11810
11811 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
11812 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
11813 Connection error during SSL handshake
11814
11815 Field Format Extract from the example above
11816 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
11817 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
11818 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
11819 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
11820 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
11821
11822These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
11823failures.
11824
11825
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118268.3. Advanced logging options
11827-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011828
11829Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
11830just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
11831options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
11832for more information about their usage.
11833
11834
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118358.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
11836------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011837
11838It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
11839haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
11840commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
11841monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
11842ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
11843
11844 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
11845 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
11846 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
11847 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
11848
11849 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
11850 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
11851 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011852 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011853 such as other load-balancers.
11854
11855 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
11856 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
11857 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
11858
11859
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118608.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
11861----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011862
11863The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
11864what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
11865or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
11866"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
11867just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
11868log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
11869after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
11870is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
11871with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
11872with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
11873
11874
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118758.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
11876------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011877
11878Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
11879for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
11880"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
11881retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
11882raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
11883a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
11884file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
11885you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
11886"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
11887
11888
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118898.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
11890--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011891
11892Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
11893multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
11894them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
11895"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
11896logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
11897error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
11898and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
11899too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
11900useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
11901alternative.
11902
11903
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119048.4. Timing events
11905------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011906
11907Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
11908reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
11909the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
11910frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
11911mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
11912
11913 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
11914 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
11915 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
11916 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
11917 the client closes prematurely or times out.
11918
11919 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
11920 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
11921 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
11922 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
11923 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
11924
11925 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
11926 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
11927 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
11928 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
11929 connection never established.
11930
11931 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
11932 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
11933 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
11934 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
11935 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
11936 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
11937 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
11938 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
11939 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
11940 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
11941 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
11942
11943 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
11944 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
11945 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
11946 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011947 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011948
11949 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
11950
11951 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
11952 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
11953 negative.
11954
11955These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
11956protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
11957that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011958due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011959close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
11960session has been aborted on timeout.
11961
11962Most common cases :
11963
11964 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11965 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
11966 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
11967 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
11968 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
11969 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
11970 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
11971 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
11972 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020011973 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
11974 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
11975 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011976
11977 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11978 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
11979 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
11980 of ms on remote networks.
11981
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011982 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
11983 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
11984 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011985
11986 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
11987 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
11988 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
11989 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
11990 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
11991 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
11992 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
11993 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
11994 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
11995 to the server until another one is released.
11996
11997Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
11998
11999 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12000 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12001 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12002
12003 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12004 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12005 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12006
12007 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12008 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12009 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12010 flags.
12011
12012 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12013 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12014 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12015 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12016 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12017 the client connection was maintained open.
12018
12019 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012020 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012021 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12022 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12023
12024
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120258.5. Session state at disconnection
12026-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012027
12028TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12029"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
120302-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12031each of which has a special meaning :
12032
12033 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12034 session to terminate :
12035
12036 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12037
12038 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12039 server explicitly refused it.
12040
12041 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12042 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12043 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12044 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012045 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12046
12047 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12048 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012049
12050 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12051 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12052 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12053 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12054 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12055
12056 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12057 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12058 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12059 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12060 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12061
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012062 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12063 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12064
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012065 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12066 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12067 backup connections when going up.
12068
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012069 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12070
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012071 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12072 send or receive data.
12073
12074 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12075 send or receive data.
12076
12077 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12078 with nothing left in the buffers.
12079
12080 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12081
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012082 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012083 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12084
12085 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12086 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12087 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12088 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12089 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12090
12091 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12092 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12093
12094 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12095 server (HTTP only).
12096
12097 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12098
12099 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12100 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12101 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12102
12103 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12104 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12105 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12106
12107 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12108
12109 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12110 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12111
12112 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12113 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12114 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12115
12116 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12117 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012118 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12119 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012120
12121 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12122 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12123 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12124 another server.
12125
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012126 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012127 server.
12128
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012129 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12130 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12131 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12132 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12133
12134 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12135 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12136 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12137 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12138
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012139 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12140 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12141 "use-server" rule).
12142
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012143 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12144
12145 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12146 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12147
12148 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12149
12150 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12151 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12152 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12153
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012154 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12155 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012156 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012157 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12158 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12159
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012160 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12161
12162 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12163 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12164
12165 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12166
12167 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12168
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012169The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12170was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012171helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12172starvation, attacks, etc...
12173
12174The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12175alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12176easier finding and understanding.
12177
12178 Flags Reason
12179
12180 -- Normal termination.
12181
12182 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12183 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12184 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12185 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12186
12187 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12188 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12189 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12190 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12191 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12192 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012193
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012194 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12195 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012196 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012197
12198 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12199 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12200 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12201
12202 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12203 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12204 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12205 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12206 the server takes too long to respond.
12207
12208 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12209 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12210 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12211 long a time to respond.
12212
12213 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12214 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12215 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12216 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12217 and the client.
12218
12219 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12220 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12221 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12222 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12223 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
12224 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
12225
12226 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12227 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012228 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12229 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12230 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12231 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012232
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012233 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12234 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12235
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012236 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012237 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12238 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12239 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12240 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12241 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12242
12243 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12244 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12245 503 or 504 here.
12246
12247 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12248 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12249 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12250 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12251 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12252
12253 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12254 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012255 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012256 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12257 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12258
12259 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12260 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12261 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12262 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12263 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12264 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12265 between haproxy and the server.
12266
12267 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12268 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12269 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12270 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12271 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12272 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12273 solution is to fix the application.
12274
12275 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12276 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12277 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12278 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12279 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12280 external attacks.
12281
12282 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12283 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012284 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012285 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12286 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12287
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012288 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12289 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12290 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012291 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12292 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012293
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012294 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12295 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12296 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12297 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012298 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12299 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12300 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12301 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12302 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012303
12304 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12305 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12306 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12307 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12308
12309 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12310 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12311 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12312 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12313
12314 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12315 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12316 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12317 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12318
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012319The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12320persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12321important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12322re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12323
12324 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12325
12326 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12327 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12328 set on a GET request.
12329
12330 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12331 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012332 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012333 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12334
12335 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12336 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12337 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12338
12339 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12340 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12341 already got a cookie.
12342
12343 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12344 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12345 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12346 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12347 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12348
12349 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12350 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12351 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12352
12353 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12354 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12355 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12356
12357 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12358 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12359
12360 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12361 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12362 then advertised in the response.
12363
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012364
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123658.6. Non-printable characters
12366-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012367
12368In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12369consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12370converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12371prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12372being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12373escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12374is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12375'}' when logging headers.
12376
12377Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12378issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12379containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12380
12381Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12382the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12383performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12384
12385
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123868.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12387---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012388
12389Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12390achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012391section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012392cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12393the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12394the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012395locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012396not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12397user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12398a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12399wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12400
12401 Examples :
12402 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12403 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12404
12405 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12406 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12407
12408
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124098.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12410---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012411
12412Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12413proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12414the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12415server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12416
12417Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12418response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012419section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012420
12421It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012422time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12423appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012424are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12425and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12426follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12427request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12428in the logs.
12429
12430 Example :
12431 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12432 listen proxy-out
12433 mode http
12434 option httplog
12435 option logasap
12436 log global
12437 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12438
12439 # log the name of the virtual server
12440 capture request header Host len 20
12441
12442 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12443 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12444
12445 # log the beginning of the referrer
12446 capture request header Referer len 20
12447
12448 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12449 capture response header Server len 20
12450
12451 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12452 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12453
12454 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12455 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12456
12457 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12458 capture response header Via len 20
12459
12460 # log the URL location during a redirection
12461 capture response header Location len 20
12462
12463 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12464 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12465 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12466 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12467 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12468
12469 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12470 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12471 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12472 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012473 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012474
12475 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12476 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12477 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12478 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12479 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012480 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012481
12482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124838.9. Examples of logs
12484---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012485
12486These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12487them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12488reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
12489
12490 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
12491 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12492 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12493
12494 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
12495 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
12496
12497 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
12498 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
12499 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12500
12501 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
12502 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
12503
12504 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
12505 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12506 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
12507
12508 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012509 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012510 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
12511 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
12512
12513 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
12514 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
12515 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
12516
12517 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
12518 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020012519 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012520 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
12521 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
12522 to return the 502 and not the server.
12523
12524 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012525 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012526
12527 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
12528 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
12529 Nothing was sent to any server.
12530
12531 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
12532 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
12533
12534 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
12535 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
12536 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
12537 send a 408 return code to the client.
12538
12539 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
12540 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
12541
12542 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
12543 5 seconds ("c----").
12544
12545 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
12546 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012547 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012548
12549 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012550 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012551 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
12552 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
12553 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
12554 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
12555 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012556
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012557
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125589. Statistics and monitoring
12559----------------------------
12560
12561It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
12562mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
12563CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
12564Unix socket.
12565
12566
125679.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012568---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012569
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010012570The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
12571page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
12572
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012573 0. pxname: proxy name
12574 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
12575 for server)
12576 2. qcur: current queued requests
12577 3. qmax: max queued requests
12578 4. scur: current sessions
12579 5. smax: max sessions
12580 6. slim: sessions limit
12581 7. stot: total sessions
12582 8. bin: bytes in
12583 9. bout: bytes out
12584 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012585 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012586 12. ereq: request errors
12587 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012588 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012589 15. wretr: retries (warning)
12590 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010012591 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012592 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
12593 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
12594 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
12595 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
12596 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
12597 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
12598 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
12599 25. qlimit: queue limit
12600 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
12601 27. iid: unique proxy id
12602 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
12603 29. throttle: warm up status
12604 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
12605 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020012606 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020012607 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
12608 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
12609 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012610 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012611 UNK -> unknown
12612 INI -> initializing
12613 SOCKERR -> socket error
12614 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
12615 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
12616 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
12617 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
12618 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
12619 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12620 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12621 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
12622 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
12623 disable-on-404
12624 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12625 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12626 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012627 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
12628 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012629 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
12630 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
12631 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
12632 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
12633 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
12634 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012635 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
12636 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
12637 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
12638 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012639 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
12640 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010012641 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
12642 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
12643 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010012644 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreauf522f3d2014-02-10 22:22:49 +010012645 55. lastsess: number of seconds since last session assigned to server/backend
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012646
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012647
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126489.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012649-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012650
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012651The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
12652necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
12653A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
12654issuing commands by hand :
12655
12656 global
12657 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12658 stats timeout 2m
12659
12660It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
12661the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
12662never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
12663situations :
12664
12665 global
12666 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12667 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
12668 stats timeout 2m
12669
12670To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
12671swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
12672to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
12673syntaxes we'll use are the following :
12674
12675 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
12676 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
12677
12678The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
12679script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
12680for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
12681
12682The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
12683that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
12684editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
12685(eg: watch a counter).
12686
12687The socket supports two operation modes :
12688 - interactive
12689 - non-interactive
12690
12691The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
12692this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
12693sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
12694mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
12695commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
12696example :
12697
12698 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
12699
12700The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
12701entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
12702for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
12703sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
12704"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
12705after processing the last command of the same line.
12706
12707For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
12708"prompt" command :
12709
12710 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
12711 prompt
12712 > show info
12713 ...
12714 >
12715
12716Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
12717delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
12718that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
12719parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012720
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012721It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
12722on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
12723own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012724
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012725The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
12726If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
12727all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
12728it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
12729
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012730add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012731 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
12732 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
12733 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
12734 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012735
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012736add map <map> <key> <value>
12737 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
12738 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012739 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
12740 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
12741 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012742
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012743clear counters
12744 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
12745 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
12746 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
12747 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
12748 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12749
12750clear counters all
12751 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
12752 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
12753 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
12754
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012755clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012756 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
12757 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
12758 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012759
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012760clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012761 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
12762 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
12763 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012764
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012765clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
12766 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
12767
12768 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
12769 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
12770 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
12771 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
12772 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
12773 later after the session ends is usual enough.
12774
12775 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
12776
12777 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
12778 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
12779 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
12780 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
12781 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
12782 the ACLs :
12783
12784 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12785 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12786 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12787 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12788 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12789 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12790
12791 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012792 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
12793 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012794
12795 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012796 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012797 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012798 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12799 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12800 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12801 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012802
12803 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12804
12805 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012806 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012807 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12808 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012809 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12810 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12811 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012812
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012813del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
12814 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012815 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
12816 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
12817 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
12818 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012819
12820del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010012821 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012822 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
12823 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
12824 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
12825 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010012826
12827disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012828 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
12829
12830 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
12831 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
12832 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
12833 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
12834 re-enabled using enable agent.
12835
12836 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
12837 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
12838 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
12839 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
12840 otherwise unchanged.
12841
12842 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
12843 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
12844 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
12845
12846 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12847 level "admin".
12848
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012849disable frontend <frontend>
12850 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
12851 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
12852 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
12853 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
12854 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
12855 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
12856 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
12857 on the stats page.
12858
12859 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12860 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12861
12862 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12863 level "admin".
12864
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012865disable server <backend>/<server>
12866 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
12867 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
12868 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
12869 during the maintenance.
12870
12871 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
12872 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
12873
12874 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012875 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012876
12877 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12878 level "admin".
12879
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012880enable agent <backend>/<server>
12881 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
12882
12883 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
12884 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
12885
12886 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12887 level "admin".
12888
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012889enable frontend <frontend>
12890 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
12891 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
12892 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
12893 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
12894 which was disabled.
12895
12896 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12897 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12898
12899 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12900 level "admin".
12901
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012902enable server <backend>/<server>
12903 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
12904 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
12905
12906 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012907 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012908
12909 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12910 level "admin".
12911
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010012912get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012913get acl <acl> <value>
12914 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
12915 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
12916 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
12917 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
12918 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010012919
12920 The first two words are:
12921
12922 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
12923 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
12924 "dom", "end" or "reg".
12925
12926 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
12927
12928 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
12929
12930 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
12931
12932 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
12933 interpretation of the case.
12934
12935 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
12936 useful with regular expressions.
12937
12938 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
12939 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
12940
12941 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
12942 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
12943 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
12944
12945 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
12946
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012947get weight <backend>/<server>
12948 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
12949 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
12950 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
12951 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
12952 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012953 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012954
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012955help
12956 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
12957 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012958
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012959prompt
12960 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
12961 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
12962 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
12963 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
12964 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
12965 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
12966 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
12967 command.
12968
12969quit
12970 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012971
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012972set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012973 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
12974 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
12975 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012976
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012977set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020012978 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
12979 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
12980 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
12981 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
12982 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012983 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
12984 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12985
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020012986set maxconn global <maxconn>
12987 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
12988 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
12989 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
12990 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
12991 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
12992 setting.
12993
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020012994set rate-limit connections global <value>
12995 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
12996 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12997 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12998 is passed in number of connections per second.
12999
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013000set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13001 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13002 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013003 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13004 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013005
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013006set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13007 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13008 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13009 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13010 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13011
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013012set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13013 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13014 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13015 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13016 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13017 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13018
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013019set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013020 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13021 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13022 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13023 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013024 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13025 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013026
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013027set timeout cli <delay>
13028 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13029 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13030 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13031
13032set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13033 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13034 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013035 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13036 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13037 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13038 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13039 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13040 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13041 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13042 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13043 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13044 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13045 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13046 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13047 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013048
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013049show errors [<iid>]
13050 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13051 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013052 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13053 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13054 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013055
13056 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13057 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13058 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13059 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13060 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13061 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13062 are reported too.
13063
13064 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13065 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13066 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13067 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13068 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13069 code.
13070
13071 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13072 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13073 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13074 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13075 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13076 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13077 line.
13078
13079 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013080 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13081 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013082 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13083 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13084
13085 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13086 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13087 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13088 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13089 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13090 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13091 00204+ minal\r\n
13092 00211 \r\n
13093
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013094 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013095 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13096 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13097 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13098 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13099 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13100 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013101
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013102show info
13103 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13104
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013105show map [<map>]
13106 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013107 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13108 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13109 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13110 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13111 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13112 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013113
13114show acl [<acl>]
13115 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013116 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13117 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13118 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13119 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13120 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013121
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013122show pools
13123 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13124 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13125 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13126 the pools.
13127
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013128show sess
13129 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013130 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13131 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13132
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013133show sess <id>
13134 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13135 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13136 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13137 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13138 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010013139 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
13140 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
13141 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013142
13143show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13144 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13145 possible to dump only selected items :
13146 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13147 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13148 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13149 for example:
13150 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13151 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13152 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13153
13154 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013155 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13156 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013157 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13158 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13159 Nbproc: 1
13160 Process_num: 1
13161 (...)
13162
13163 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13164 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13165 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13166 (...)
13167 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13168
13169 $
13170
13171 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13172 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13173 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13174 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013175 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013176
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013177show table
13178 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13179 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13180 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13181 entries currently in use.
13182
13183 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013184 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013185 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13186 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013187
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013188show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013189 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13190 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13191 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013192 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13193
13194 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13195 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13196 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13197 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13198 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13199
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013200 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13201 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13202 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13203 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13204 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13205 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13206
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013207
13208 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013209 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13210 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013211
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013212 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013213 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013214 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013215 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13216 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13217 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13218 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013219
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013220 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013221 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013222 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13223 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013224
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013225 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13226 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013227 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013228 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13229 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013230
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013231 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13232 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013233 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013234 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13235 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13236
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013237 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13238 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13239 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13240 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13241 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13242
13243 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13244 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13245 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013246 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13247 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013248 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13249 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013250
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013251shutdown frontend <frontend>
13252 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13253 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13254 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13255 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13256 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13257 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13258 once it is terminated.
13259
13260 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13261 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13262
13263 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13264 level "admin".
13265
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013266shutdown session <id>
13267 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13268 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13269 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13270 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13271 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13272 flag in the logs.
13273
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013274shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
13275 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13276 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13277 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13278 'K' flag in the logs.
13279
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013280/*
13281 * Local variables:
13282 * fill-column: 79
13283 * End:
13284 */